blob: 29529641e2d673b10779d563e3e5719c20f703f9 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Christopher Fauletcac16312021-07-16 08:34:06 +02007 2021/07/16
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
676. HTTP header manipulation
68
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
707.1. ACL basics
717.1.1. Matching booleans
727.1.2. Matching integers
737.1.3. Matching strings
747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
787.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200797.3.1. Converters
807.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086
878. Logging
888.1. Log levels
898.2. Log formats
908.2.1. Default log format
918.2.2. TCP log format
928.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100938.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100948.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200958.3. Advanced logging options
968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1008.4. Timing events
1018.5. Session state at disconnection
1028.6. Non-printable characters
1038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1058.9. Examples of logs
106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001079. Supported filters
1089.1. Trace
1099.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001109.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001119.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200112
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011310. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011410.1. Limitation
11510.2. Setup
11610.2.1. Cache section
11710.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118
1191. Quick reminder about HTTP
120----------------------------
121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
124on almost anything found in the contents.
125
126However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
127formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
128correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
129
130
1311.1. The HTTP transaction model
132-------------------------------
133
134The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100135to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
137connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138will involve a new connection :
139
140 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
141
142In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
143establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
144by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
145length.
146
147Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
148to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
149however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
150response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
151header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
156power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
157but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100160Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
162second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
163page :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
168latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
169correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
170the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100171server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
174time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
175are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
176parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
177carry the stream identifier.
178
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100179By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
180connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
181leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
183processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
184waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200185
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200186HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
188 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100189 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200191 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194
1951.2. HTTP request
196-----------------
197
198First, let's consider this HTTP request :
199
200 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100201 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
203 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
204 3 User-agent: my small browser
205 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
206 5 Accept: image/png
207
208
2091.2.1. The Request line
210-----------------------
211
212Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
213
214 - a METHOD : GET
215 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
216 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
217
218All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
219which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
220followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
221is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
222desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
223the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
224
225The URI itself can have several forms :
226
227 - A "relative URI" :
228
229 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
230
231 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
232 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
233
234 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
235
236 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
237
238 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
239 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
240 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
241 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
242 must accept this form too.
243
244 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
245 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
246 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100247
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200248 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
249 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
250 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
251 other protocols too.
252
253In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
254mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
255on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
256It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
257specific to the language, framework or application in use.
258
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100259HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100260assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200262
2631.2.2. The request headers
264--------------------------
265
266The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
267beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
268an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
269Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
270values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
271encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
272the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
273define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
274
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200276their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau371ab182020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200278as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
279normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
280representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
281HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200282
283The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
284that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
285is one valid form of empty line.
286
287Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
288headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
289about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
290application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
291
292Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000293 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
295 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
296 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
297
298
2991.3. HTTP response
300------------------
301
302An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
303messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
304
305 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100306 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200307 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
308 2 Content-length: 350
309 3 Content-Type: text/html
310
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200311As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
312codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
313response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100314continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
315the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
316following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
317sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
318(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
319correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
320such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
321state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
322over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
323if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
324information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200325
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003271.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200328------------------------
329
330Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
331
332 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
333 - a status code : 200
334 - a reason : OK
335
336The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100337 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
338 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
339 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
340 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
341 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000343Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100344"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
346messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
347or "Authentication Required".
348
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100349HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350
351 Code When / reason
352 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
353 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
354 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
355 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100356 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
357 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358 400 for an invalid or too large request
359 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
360 accessing the stats page)
361 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
Florian Tham9f3bda02020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100362 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Thamc09f7972020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100364 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
365 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
367 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
368 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
369 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
370 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
371 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
372 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
373
374The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3754.2).
376
377
3781.3.2. The response headers
379---------------------------
380
381Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
382the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
383details.
384
385
3862. Configuring HAProxy
387----------------------
388
3892.1. Configuration file format
390------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200391
392HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
393
394 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
395 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
396 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
397 "frontend" and "backend".
398
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100399The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
400referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200401delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100402
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200403
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004042.2. Quoting and escaping
405-------------------------
406
407HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
408many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
409with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
410single quotes.
411
412If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
413them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
414escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
415
416Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
417
418 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
419 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
420 \\ to use a backslash
421 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
422 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
423
424Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
425the interpretation of:
426
427 space as a parameter separator
428 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
429 # hash as a comment start
430
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200431Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
432-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
433backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
434
435Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200436quoting.
437
438Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
439nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
440
441Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
442equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
443
444 Example:
445 # those are equivalents:
446 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
447 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
448 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
451
452 # those are equivalents:
453 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
454 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
455 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
457
458
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004592.3. Environment variables
460--------------------------
461
462HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
463interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
464configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
465optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
466shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
467underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
468
469 Example:
470
471 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
472
473 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
474
475 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
476
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200477Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
478file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200480* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
481 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
482
483* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
484 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
485 directory.
486
487* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
488
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500489* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200490 processes, separated by semicolons.
491
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500492* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493 CLI, separated by semicolons.
494
495See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200496
4972.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200498----------------
499
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100500Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100501values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
502otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
503numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
504for every keyword. Supported units are :
505
506 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
507 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
508 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
509 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
510 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
511 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
512
513
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005142.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200515-------------
516
517 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
518 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
519 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
520 global
521 daemon
522 maxconn 256
523
524 defaults
525 mode http
526 timeout connect 5000ms
527 timeout client 50000ms
528 timeout server 50000ms
529
530 frontend http-in
531 bind *:80
532 default_backend servers
533
534 backend servers
535 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
536
537
538 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
539 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
540 global
541 daemon
542 maxconn 256
543
544 defaults
545 mode http
546 timeout connect 5000ms
547 timeout client 50000ms
548 timeout server 50000ms
549
550 listen http-in
551 bind *:80
552 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
553
554
555Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
556
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100557 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200558
559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005603. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200561--------------------
562
563Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
564are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
565of them have command-line equivalents.
566
567The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
568
569 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200570 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200571 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200572 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200575 - description
576 - deviceatlas-json-file
577 - deviceatlas-log-level
578 - deviceatlas-separator
579 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900580 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200581 - gid
582 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100583 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200584 - h1-case-adjust
585 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100588 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200590 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200592 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200593 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100595 - presetenv
596 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - uid
598 - ulimit-n
599 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200600 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100601 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200602 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200603 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200604 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - ssl-default-bind-options
606 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200607 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - ssl-default-server-options
609 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100610 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100611 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100612 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100613 - 51degrees-data-file
614 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200615 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200616 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200617 - wurfl-data-file
618 - wurfl-information-list
619 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200620 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100621
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200622 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200623 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200624 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200625 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100626 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100627 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100628 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200629 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200630 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200631 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200632 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633 - noepoll
634 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000635 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100637 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300638 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000639 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100640 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200641 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200642 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200643 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000644 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000645 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200646 - tune.buffers.limit
647 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200648 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200649 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100650 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200651 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200652 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200653 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100654 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200655 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200656 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100657 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100658 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100659 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100660 - tune.lua.session-timeout
661 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200662 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100663 - tune.maxaccept
664 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200665 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200666 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200667 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua5e11c02020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200668 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
669 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100670 - tune.rcvbuf.client
671 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100672 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200673 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100674 - tune.sndbuf.client
675 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100676 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100677 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200678 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100679 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200680 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200681 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100682 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200683 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100684 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200685 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
686 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
687 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100688 - tune.zlib.memlevel
689 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100690
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200691 * Debugging
692 - debug
693 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200694
695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006963.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200697------------------------------------
698
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200699ca-base <dir>
700 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200701 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
702 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200703
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200704chroot <jail dir>
705 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
706 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
707 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
708 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
709 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100710 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100711
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
713 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
714 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
715 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
716 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
717 set. These sets have the format
718
719 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
720
721 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100722 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100723 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
724 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100725 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
726 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100727 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100728 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100729 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100730 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100731 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
732 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
733 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
734 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100735
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100736 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
737 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
738 on the machine's word size.
739
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100740 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100741 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
742 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
743 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
744 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
745 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
746 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100747
748 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100749 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
750
751 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
752 # first 4 CPUs
753
754 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
755 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
756 # word size.
757
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100758 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100760 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
761 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
762 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
763
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100764 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
765 # and so on.
766 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
767 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
768 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
769
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100770 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100771 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
772 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
773 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
774
775 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
776 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
777 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
778
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100779 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
780 # and a thread range.
781 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
782 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
783 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
784
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200785crt-base <dir>
786 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
787 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
788 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
789
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200790daemon
791 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
792 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100793 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
794 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200795
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200796deviceatlas-json-file <path>
797 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100798 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200799
800deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100801 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200802 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
803
804deviceatlas-separator <char>
805 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
806 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
807
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100808deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200809 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
810 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
811 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100812
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900813external-check
814 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
815 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
816 See "option external-check".
817
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200818gid <number>
Thayne McCombs31d31f92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700819 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
821 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100822 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
823 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200824 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100825
Willy Tarreau8b852462019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100826group <group name>
827 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
828 See also "gid" and "user".
829
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100830hard-stop-after <time>
831 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
832
833 Arguments :
834 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
835 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
836 SIGUSR1 signal.
837
838 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
839 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
840 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
841
842 Example:
843 global
844 hard-stop-after 30s
845
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200846h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
847 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
848 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
849 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
850 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin5c836fd2020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500851 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200852 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
853 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
854 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
855 specified in a proxy.
856
857 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
858 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
859 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
860 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
861 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
862 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
863 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
864
865 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
866 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
867 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
868 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
869 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
870
871 Example:
872 global
873 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
874
875 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
876 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
877
878h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
879 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
880 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
881 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
882 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
883 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
884 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
885 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
886 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
887
888 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
889 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
890 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
891
892 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
893 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
894
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200895log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
896 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100897 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100898 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100899 configured with "log global".
900
901 <address> can be one of:
902
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100903 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100904 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
905 port).
906
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100907 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
908 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
909 port).
910
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100911 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100912 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
913 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100914 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100915
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100916 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
917 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
918 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
919 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
920 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
921 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
922 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
923 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
924 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
925 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
926 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
927 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
928 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
929 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100930 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
931 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100932
933 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
934 "fd@2", see above.
935
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200936 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
937 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100938
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200939 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
940 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
941 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
942 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
943 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
944 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
945 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
946 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
947 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
948 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100949 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
950 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200951
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200952 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
953 one of the following :
954
955 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
956 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
957
958 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
959 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
960
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100961 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
962 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
963 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
964 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
965 logger consumes.
966
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100967 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
968 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
969 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
970 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
971
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200972 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
973 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
974 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
975 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
976 set with <sample_size> parameter.
977
978 <sample_size>
979 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
980 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
981 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
982 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
983 (see also <ranges> parameter).
984
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100985 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200986
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100987 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
988 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
989 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
990
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100991 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
992 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
993 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
994 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995
996 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200997 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
998 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
999 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1000 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1001 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1002 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001003
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001004 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001005
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001006log-send-hostname [<string>]
1007 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1008 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1009 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1010 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1011 the logs.
1012
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001013log-tag <string>
1014 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1015 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1016 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001017 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001018
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001019lua-load <file>
1020 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1021 used multiple times.
1022
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001023master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001024 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1025 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1026 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001027 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001028 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1029 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001030 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1031 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1032 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1033 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1034 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001035
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001036 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001037
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001038mworker-max-reloads <number>
1039 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001040 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001041 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1042 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1043 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1044
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001045nbproc <number>
1046 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1047 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1048 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001049 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1050 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001051 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1052 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001053
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001054nbthread <number>
1055 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001056 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1057 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1058 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1059 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1060 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001061 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1062 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1063 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1064 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1065 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1066 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1067 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001068
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001069pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001070 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001071 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1072 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1073
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001074presetenv <name> <value>
1075 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1076 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1077 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1078 and "unsetenv".
1079
1080resetenv [<name> ...]
1081 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1082 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1083 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1084 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1085 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1086 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1087 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1088 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1089
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001090stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001091 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1092 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1093 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1094 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1095 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1096 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001097 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001098 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1099 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1100 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1101 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001102
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001103server-state-base <directory>
1104 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001105 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1106 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001107
1108server-state-file <file>
1109 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1110 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1111 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1112 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1113 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1114 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1115 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1116 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001117 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1118 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001119
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001120setenv <name> <value>
1121 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1122 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1123 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1124 and "unsetenv".
1125
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001126set-dumpable
1127 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1128 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1129 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1130 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1131 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1132 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1133 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1134 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1135 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1136 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1137 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1138 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1139 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1140 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1141 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1142 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1143 expected when dying.
1144
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001145ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1147 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001148 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001149 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001150 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1151 information and recommendations see e.g.
1152 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1153 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1154 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1155 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001156
1157ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1158 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1159 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1160 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1161 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1162 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001163 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1164 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1165 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001166 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001167
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001168ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1169 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1170 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1171 keyword to see available options.
1172
1173 Example:
1174 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001175 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001176
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001177ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1178 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1179 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001180 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001181 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001182 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1183 information and recommendations see e.g.
1184 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1185 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1186 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1187 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1188 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001189
1190ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1191 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1192 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1193 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1194 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1195 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001196 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1197 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1198 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1199 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001200
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001201ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1202 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1203 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1204 keyword to see available options.
1205
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001206ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1207 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1208 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1209 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001210 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001211 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001212 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1213 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1214 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1215 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001216 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1217 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1218 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1219
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001220ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1221 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1222 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1223 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1224
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001225stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1226 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1227 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1228 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001229 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001230 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001231
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001232 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1233 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1234 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001235
1236stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1237 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1238 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001239 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001240
1241stats maxconn <connections>
1242 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1243 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1244
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001245uid <number>
Thayne McCombs31d31f92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001246 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001247 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1248 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1249 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1250
1251ulimit-n <number>
1252 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1253 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1254 option.
1255
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001256unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1257 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1258
1259 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1260 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1261 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1262 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1263 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1264 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1265 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1266 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1267 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1268 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1269
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001270unsetenv [<name> ...]
1271 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1272 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1273 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1274 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1275 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1276 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1277 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1278
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001279user <user name>
1280 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1281 See also "uid" and "group".
1282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001283node <name>
1284 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1285
1286 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1287 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1288 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1289 traffic.
1290
1291description <text>
1292 Add a text that describes the instance.
1293
1294 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1295 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1296 "<" and ">" characters.
1297
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100129851degrees-data-file <file path>
1299 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001300 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001301
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001302 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001303 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1304
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000130551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001306 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1307 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1308 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1309
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001310 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001311 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1312
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200131351degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001314 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1315 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1316
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001317 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1318 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1319
132051degrees-cache-size <number>
1321 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1322 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1323 By default, this cache is disabled.
1324
1325 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001326 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1327
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001328wurfl-data-file <file path>
1329 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1330 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1331
1332 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1333 with USE_WURFL=1.
1334
1335wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1336 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1337 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1338 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1339
1340 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1341
1342 Valid WURFL properties are:
1343 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1344
1345 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1346 device.
1347
1348 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1349 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1350
1351 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1352 particular web request.
1353
1354 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1355 used Libwurfl API version.
1356
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001357 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1358 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1359
1360 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1361 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1362
1363 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1364
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001365 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1366 with USE_WURFL=1.
1367
1368wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1369 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1370 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1371
1372 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1373 with USE_WURFL=1.
1374
1375wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1376 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1377 thus before the chroot.
1378
1379 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1380 with USE_WURFL=1.
1381
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001382wurfl-cache-size <size>
1383 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1384 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001385 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001386 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001387
1388 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1389 with USE_WURFL=1.
1390
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013913.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001392-----------------------
1393
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001394busy-polling
1395 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1396 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1397 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1398 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1399 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1400 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1401 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1402 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1403 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1404 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1405 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1406 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1407 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1408 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1409 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1410 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1411 "poll" pollers.
1412
William Dauchy857b9432019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001413 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1414 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1415 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1416
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001417max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1418 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1419 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1420 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1421 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1422 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1423 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1424 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1425 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1426
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001427maxconn <number>
1428 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1429 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1430 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001431 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1432 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1433 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1434 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001435 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1436 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1437 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1438 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1439 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1440 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001441
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001442maxconnrate <number>
1443 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1444 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1445 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1446 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1447 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1448 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1449 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1450 fairness.
1451
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001452maxcomprate <number>
1453 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001454 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001455 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1456 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1457 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001458 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001459 default value.
1460
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001461maxcompcpuusage <number>
1462 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1463 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1464 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1465 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1466 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1467 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1468 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1469 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1470
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001471maxpipes <number>
1472 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1473 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1474 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1475 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1476 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1477 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1478
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001479maxsessrate <number>
1480 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1481 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1482 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1483 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1484 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1485 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1486 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1487 fairness.
1488
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001489maxsslconn <number>
1490 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1491 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1492 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1493 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1494 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1495 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1496 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001497 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1498 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1499 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1500 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1501 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1502 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1503 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001504
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001505maxsslrate <number>
1506 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1507 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1508 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1509 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1510 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1511 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1512 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1513 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1514 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1515 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1516
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001517maxzlibmem <number>
1518 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1519 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1520 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001521 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1522 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1523 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1524
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001525noepoll
1526 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1527 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001528 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001529
1530nokqueue
1531 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1532 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1533 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1534
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001535noevports
1536 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1537 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1538 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1539 also "nopoll".
1540
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001541nopoll
1542 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1543 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001544 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001545 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1546 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001547
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001548nosplice
1549 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001550 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001551 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001552 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001553 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1554 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1555 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1556 "option splice-response".
1557
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001558nogetaddrinfo
1559 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1560 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1561
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001562noreuseport
1563 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1564 command line argument "-dR".
1565
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001566profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1567 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1568 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1569 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1570 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001571 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001572 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1573 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1574 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1575 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1576
1577 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1578 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1579 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1580 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1581 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001582 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1583 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1584 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1585 CLI.
1586
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001587spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001588 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1589 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1590 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1591 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1592 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1593 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001594
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001595ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001596 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001597 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001598 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1599 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1600 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1601 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1602 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001603 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1604 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001605 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1606 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1607 openssl configuration file uses:
1608 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1609
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001610ssl-mode-async
1611 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001612 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001613 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1614 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1615 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001616 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001617 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001618
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001619tune.buffers.limit <number>
1620 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1621 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1622 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1623 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1624 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001625 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001626 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1627 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1628 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1629 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1630 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1631 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1632 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1633 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1634 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1635
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001636tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1637 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1638 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1639 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1640 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1641
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001642tune.bufsize <number>
1643 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1644 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1645 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1646 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1647 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1648 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1649 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001650 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1651 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1652 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001653 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001654 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1655 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1656 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001657
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001658tune.chksize <number>
1659 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1660 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1661 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1662 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1663 checks whenever possible.
1664
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001665tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1666 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1667 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1668 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1669 this value. The default value is 1.
1670
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001671tune.fail-alloc
1672 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1673 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1674 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1675 gracefully.
1676
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001677tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1678 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1679 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1680 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1681 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1682 change it.
1683
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001684tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1685 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001686 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1687 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001688 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1689 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1690 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1691 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1692 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1693
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001694tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1695 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1696 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1697 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1698 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1699 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1700 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1701 recommended not to change this value.
1702
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001703tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1704 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1705 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1706 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1707 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1708 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1709 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1710 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1711
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001712tune.http.cookielen <number>
1713 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1714 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1715 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1716 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1717 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1718 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1719 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1720 to change this value.
1721
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001722tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001723 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1724 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001725 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001726 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001727 configuration directives too.
1728 The default value is 1024.
1729
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001730tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1731 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1732 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1733 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1734 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1735 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1736 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001737 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1738 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1739 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001740
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001741tune.idletimer <timeout>
1742 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1743 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1744 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1745 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1746 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1747 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001748 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001749 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001750 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1751
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001752tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1753 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1754 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1755 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1756 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1757 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1758 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1759 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1760 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1761 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1762
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001763tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1764 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001765 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001766 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1767 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001768 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001769 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1770 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1771
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001772tune.lua.maxmem
1773 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1774 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1775 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1776 memory.
1777
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001778tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1779 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001780 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1781 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001782 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001783
1784tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1785 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1786 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1787 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1788 check servers.
1789
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001790tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1791 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1792 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1793 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001794 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001795
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001796tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001797 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1798 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1799 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1800 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1801 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1802 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1803 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1804 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1805 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1806 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001807
1808tune.maxpollevents <number>
1809 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1810 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1811 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1812 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1813 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1814
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001815tune.maxrewrite <number>
1816 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1817 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1818 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1819 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1820 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1821 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1822 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1823 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1824 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1825 bufsize.
1826
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001827tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1828 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1829 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1830 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1831 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1832 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1833 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1834 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1835 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1836 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau7fdd81c2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001837 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1838 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001839 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1840 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1841 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1842 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1843 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1844 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1845 setting this parameter to 0.
1846
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001847tune.pipesize <number>
1848 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1849 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1850 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1851 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1852 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1853 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1854
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001855tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1856 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1857 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1858 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1859 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1860 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1861 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001862 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001863
Willy Tarreauc55e3e12020-07-01 18:30:16 +02001864tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1865 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1866 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1867 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1868 default is 20.
1869
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001870tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1871tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1872 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1873 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1874 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001875 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001876 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001877 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1878 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1879
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001880tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001881 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001882 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1883 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1884 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1885 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1886
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001887tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001888 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001889 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1890 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1891
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001892tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1893tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1894 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1895 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1896 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001897 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001898 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001899 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1900 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1901 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1902 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1903 notifying haproxy again.
1904
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001905tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001906 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1907 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1908 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001909 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001910 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001911 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001912 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1913 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1914 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001915 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1916 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001917
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001918tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001919 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001920 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1921 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1922 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1923 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1924 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1925
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001926tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1927 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001928 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001929 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1930 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1931 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1932 being used for too long.
1933
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001934tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1935 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1936 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1937 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1938 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1939 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1940 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1941 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1942 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1943 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1944 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001945 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001946 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001947
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001948tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1949 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1950 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1951 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1952 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1953 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1954 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1955 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001956 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1957 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001958
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001959tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1960 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1961 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1962 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1963 1000 entries.
1964
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001965tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1966 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1967 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1968 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1969
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001970tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001971tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001972tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1973tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1974tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001975 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1976 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1977 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1978 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1979 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1980 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1981 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1982 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001983
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001984 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1985 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1986 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1987 all available space is consumed.
1988 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1989 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1990 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001991
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001992tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1993 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001994 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001995 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001996 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001997 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1998
1999tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2000 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2001 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002002 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2003 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020053.3. Debugging
2006--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002007
2008debug
2009 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2010 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2011 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2012 system startup.
2013
2014quiet
2015 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2016 line argument "-q".
2017
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020193.4. Userlists
2020--------------
2021It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2022http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2023it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2024
2025userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002026 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002027 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2028
2029group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002030 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002031 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2032 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2033
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002034user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2035 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002036 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2037 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002038 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2039 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2040 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2041 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002042
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002043 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2044 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2045 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2046 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2047 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2048 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2049 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2050 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2051 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002052
2053 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002054 userlist L1
2055 group G1 users tiger,scott
2056 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002057
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002058 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2059 user scott insecure-password elgato
2060 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002061
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002062 userlist L2
2063 group G1
2064 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002065
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002066 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2067 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2068 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002069
2070 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002071
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002072
20733.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002074----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002075It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2076several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2077instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2078values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2079automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2080In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2081using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2082tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2083reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2084Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2085that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2086each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002087
2088peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002089 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002090 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2091
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002092bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2093 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2094 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2095
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002096disabled
2097 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2098 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2099 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2100
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002101default-bind [param*]
2102 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2103
2104default-server [param*]
2105 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2106
2107 Arguments:
2108 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2109 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2110 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2111 details.
2112
2113
2114 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2115
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002116enable
2117 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2118
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002119peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002120 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2121 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2122 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2123 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2124 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2125 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2126
2127 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2128 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2129
2130 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2131 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2132 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2133 across all peers.
2134
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002135 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2136 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002137
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002138 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2139 "server" keyword explanation below).
2140
2141server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002142 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002143 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2144 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2145 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2146 of this "peers" section).
2147 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2148
2149
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002150 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002151 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002152 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002153 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2154 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2155 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002156
2157 backend mybackend
2158 mode tcp
2159 balance roundrobin
2160 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2161 stick on src
2162
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002163 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2164 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002165
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002166 Example:
2167 peers mypeers
2168 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2169 default-server ssl verify none
2170 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2171 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002172
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002173
2174table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2175 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2176
2177 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2178 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002179 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002180 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2181 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2182 "stick-table" keyword).
2183
2184 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2185 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2186 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2187 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2188 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2189 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2190 of the stick-table name as follows:
2191
2192 peers mypeers
2193 peer A ...
2194 peer B ...
2195 table t1 ...
2196
2197 frontend fe1
2198 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2199
2200 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2201 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2202
2203 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2204 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2205 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2206 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2207 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2208 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2209 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2210
2211 peers mypeers
2212 peer A ...
2213 peer B ...
2214 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2215
2216 backend t1
2217 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2218
2219 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2220 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2221 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2222
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022233.6. Mailers
2224------------
2225It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2226If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2227in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2228
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002229mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002230 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2231 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2232
2233mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2234 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2235
2236 Example:
2237 mailers mymailers
2238 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2239 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2240
2241 backend mybackend
2242 mode tcp
2243 balance roundrobin
2244
2245 email-alert mailers mymailers
2246 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2247 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2248
2249 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2250 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2251
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002252timeout mail <time>
2253 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2254 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2255 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2256 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2257
2258 Example:
2259 mailers mymailers
2260 timeout mail 20s
2261 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002262
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022633.7. Programs
2264-------------
2265In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2266master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2267managed the same way as the workers.
2268
2269During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2270sequence as a worker:
2271
2272 - the master is re-executed
2273 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2274 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2275 instance of the program
2276
2277During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2278
2279program <name>
2280 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2281 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2282 the management guide).
2283
2284command <command> [arguments*]
2285 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2286 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2287 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2288 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2289
2290option start-on-reload
2291no option start-on-reload
2292 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2293 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2294 program section.
2295
2296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022974. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002298----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002299
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002300Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002301 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002302 - frontend <name>
2303 - backend <name>
2304 - listen <name>
2305
2306A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2307its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2308section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002309section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002310
2311A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2312connections.
2313
2314A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2315to forward incoming connections.
2316
2317A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2318parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2319
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002320All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2321'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2322case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2323
2324Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2325logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2326proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2327However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2328name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2329
2330Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2331and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002332bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002333protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2334modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2335arbitrary criteria.
2336
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002337In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2338a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto599788e2019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002339the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002340
2341 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2342 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2343 between responses and new requests.
2344
2345 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2346 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2347 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002348 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2349 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2350 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2351 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002352
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002353 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2354 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2355 client-facing connection remains open.
2356
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002357 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2358 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002359
2360The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2361frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2362following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002363weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002364
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002365 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002366
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002367 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2368 ----+-----+-----+----
2369 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2370 ----+-----+-----+----
2371 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2372 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2373 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2374 ----+-----+-----+----
2375 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002376
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002377
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023794.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2380--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002381
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002382The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2383limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2384they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2385limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002386marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002387option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002388and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2389with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2390specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002391
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002392
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002393 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2394------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2395acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002396backlog X X X -
2397balance X - X X
2398bind - X X -
2399bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002400block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002401capture cookie - X X -
2402capture request header - X X -
2403capture response header - X X -
2404clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002405compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002406contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2407cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002408declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002409default-server X - X X
2410default_backend X X X -
2411description - X X X
2412disabled X X X X
2413dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002414email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002415email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002416email-alert mailers X X X X
2417email-alert myhostname X X X X
2418email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002419enabled X X X X
2420errorfile X X X X
2421errorloc X X X X
2422errorloc302 X X X X
2423-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2424errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002425force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002426filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002427fullconn X - X X
2428grace X X X X
2429hash-type X - X X
2430http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002431http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002432http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002433http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002434http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002435http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002436http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002437id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002438ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002439load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002440log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002441log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002442log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002443log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002444max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002445maxconn X X X -
2446mode X X X X
2447monitor fail - X X -
2448monitor-net X X X -
2449monitor-uri X X X -
2450option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2451option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2452option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2453option allbackups (*) X - X X
2454option checkcache (*) X - X X
2455option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2456option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Fauletfe98e742020-06-02 17:33:56 +02002457option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002458option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2459option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002460-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2461option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002462option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2463option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002464option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002465option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002466option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002467option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002468option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002469option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002470option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002471option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002472option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002473option httpchk X - X X
2474option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002475option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002476option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002477option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002478option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002479option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002480option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2481option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2482option logasap (*) X X X -
2483option mysql-check X - X X
2484option nolinger (*) X X X X
2485option originalto X X X X
2486option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002487option pgsql-check X - X X
2488option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002489option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002490option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002491option smtpchk X - X X
2492option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2493option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2494option splice-request (*) X X X X
2495option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002496option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002497option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2498option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2499-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002500option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002501option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2502option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2503option tcpka X X X X
2504option tcplog X X X X
2505option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002506external-check command X - X X
2507external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002508persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2509rate-limit sessions X X X -
2510redirect - X X X
2511redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2512redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002513reqadd (deprecated) - X X X
2514reqallow (deprecated) - X X X
2515reqdel (deprecated) - X X X
2516reqdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2517reqiallow (deprecated) - X X X
2518reqidel (deprecated) - X X X
2519reqideny (deprecated) - X X X
2520reqipass (deprecated) - X X X
2521reqirep (deprecated) - X X X
2522reqitarpit (deprecated) - X X X
2523reqpass (deprecated) - X X X
2524reqrep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002525-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002526reqtarpit (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002527retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002528retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002529rspadd (deprecated) - X X X
2530rspdel (deprecated) - X X X
2531rspdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2532rspidel (deprecated) - X X X
2533rspideny (deprecated) - X X X
2534rspirep (deprecated) - X X X
2535rsprep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002536server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002537server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002538server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002539source X - X X
2540srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002541stats admin - X X X
2542stats auth X X X X
2543stats enable X X X X
2544stats hide-version X X X X
2545stats http-request - X X X
2546stats realm X X X X
2547stats refresh X X X X
2548stats scope X X X X
2549stats show-desc X X X X
2550stats show-legends X X X X
2551stats show-node X X X X
2552stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002553-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2554stick match - - X X
2555stick on - - X X
2556stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002557stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002558stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002559tcp-check connect - - X X
2560tcp-check expect - - X X
2561tcp-check send - - X X
2562tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002563tcp-request connection - X X -
2564tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002565tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002566tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002567tcp-response content - - X X
2568tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002569timeout check X - X X
2570timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002571timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002572timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2573timeout connect X - X X
2574timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2575timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2576timeout http-request X X X X
2577timeout queue X - X X
2578timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002579timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002580timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2581timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002582timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002583transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002584unique-id-format X X X -
2585unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002586use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002587use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002588------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2589 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002590
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025924.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2593---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002594
2595This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2596
2597
2598acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2599 Declare or complete an access list.
2600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2601 no | yes | yes | yes
2602 Example:
2603 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2604 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2605 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002607 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
2609
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002610backlog <conns>
2611 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2613 yes | yes | yes | no
2614 Arguments :
2615 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2616 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002617 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002618
2619 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2620 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2621 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2622 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2623 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2624 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2625 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2626 backlog parameter.
2627
2628 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2629 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2630 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2631
2632 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2633
2634
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002635balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002636balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2639 yes | no | yes | yes
2640 Arguments :
2641 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2642 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2643 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2644 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2645
2646 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2647 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2648 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2649 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002650 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002651 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002652 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2653 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2654 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2655 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2656 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2657 it, so that you don't worry.
2658
2659 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2660 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2661 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2662 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2663 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2664 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2665 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2666 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002667
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002668 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2669 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2670 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2671 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2672 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2673 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2674 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2675 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2676
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002677 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002678 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002679 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2680 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002681 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002682 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2683 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2684 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2685 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2686 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002687 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2688 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2689 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2690 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2691 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2692 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002693
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002694 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2695 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2696 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2697 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2698 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2699 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2700 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2701 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002702 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002703 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002704 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2705 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2706 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002707
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002708 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2709 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2710 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2711 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2712 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2713 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2714 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2715 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2716 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2717 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2718 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2719 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002720
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002721 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002722 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2723 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2724 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2725 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2726 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2727 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2728 URIs start with a leading "/".
2729
2730 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2731 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2732 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2733 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2734
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002735 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002736 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2737
2738 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002739 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2740 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002741 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2742 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2743 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2744 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002745 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002746 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2747 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002748
2749 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2750 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2751 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2752 server will receive the request.
2753
2754 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2755 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2756 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2757 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2758 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002759 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2760 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2761 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002762
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002763 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2764 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2765 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2766 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2767 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002769 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002770 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2771 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2772 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2773
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002774 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2775 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2776 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2777
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002778 random
2779 random(<draws>)
2780 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002781 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2782 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2783 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2784 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002785 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2786 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2787 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2788 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2789 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2790 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2791 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2792 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2793 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2794 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2795 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2796 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2797 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2798 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2799 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2800 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2801 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2802 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2803 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2804 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002805
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002806 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002807 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002808 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2809 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2810 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2811 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2812 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2813 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002814 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002815 used instead.
2816
2817 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2818 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2819 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2820 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2821
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002822 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2823 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2824 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2825
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002826 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002827
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002828 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002829 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2830 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002831
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002832 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2833 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2834 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002835
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002836 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002837 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002838 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2839 NTLM relies on.
2840
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002841 Examples :
2842 balance roundrobin
2843 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002844 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002845 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2846 balance hdr(host)
2847 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002848
2849 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2850 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2851
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002852 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002853 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2854 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2855 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2856 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2857
2858 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2859 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2860 defaults to 16 kB.
2861
2862 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2863 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2864
2865 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2866 Round Robin.
2867
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002868 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002869 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2870 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2871 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2872
2873 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2874
2875 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002876 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002877 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2878 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2879 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002880
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002881 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002882
2883
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002884bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2885bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002886 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2888 no | yes | yes | no
2889 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002890 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2891 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2892 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2893 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002894 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002895 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2896 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2897 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2898 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2899 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2900 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2901 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002902 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2903 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2904 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2905 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2906 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2907 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2908 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002909 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2910 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2911 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002912 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2913 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2914 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2915 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002916 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2917 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2918 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002919
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002920 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2921 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002922 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2923 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2924 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002925 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2926 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2927 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2928 the range.
2929
2930 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2931 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2932 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2933 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2934 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2935 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2936 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002937 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002938 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002939
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002940 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002941 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002942 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2943 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2944 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2945 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2946 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2947 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2948
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002949 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2950 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2951 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2952 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002953
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002954 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2955 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2956 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2957 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2958 in a frontend.
2959
2960 Example :
2961 listen http_proxy
2962 bind :80,:443
2963 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002964 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002965
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002966 listen http_https_proxy
2967 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002968 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002969
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002970 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2971 bind ipv6@:80
2972 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2973 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2974
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002975 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002976 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002977
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002978 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2979 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2980 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2981 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2982 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2983
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002984 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002985 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002986
2987
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002988bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002989 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2991 yes | yes | yes | yes
2992 Arguments :
2993 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2994 may be used to override a default value.
2995
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002996 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002997 option may be combined with other numbers.
2998
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002999 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003000 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3001 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3002 missing from all processes.
3003
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003004 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003005 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003006 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3007 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3008 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3009 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3010 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003011 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003012
3013 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3014 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3015 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3016 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3017 and 'even' instances.
3018
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003019 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3020 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3021 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3022 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003023
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003024 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3025 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3026
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003027 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3028 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3029 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3030
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003031 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3032 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3033
3034 Example :
3035 listen app_ip1
3036 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003037 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003038
3039 listen app_ip2
3040 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003041 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003042
3043 listen management
3044 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003045 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003046
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003047 listen management
3048 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3049 bind-process 1-4
3050
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003051 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003052
3053
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003054block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003055 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
3056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3057 no | yes | yes | yes
3058
3059 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
3060 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003061 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003062 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003063 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003064 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
3065 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
3066 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003067
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003068 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
3069 "http-request deny" instead.
3070
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003071 Example:
3072 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3073 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3074 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03003075 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
3076 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
3077 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003078
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003079 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
3080 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
3081 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003082
3083capture cookie <name> len <length>
3084 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3086 no | yes | yes | no
3087 Arguments :
3088 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3089 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3090 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3091 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003092 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003093
3094 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3095 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3096 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3097 right if it exceeds <length>.
3098
3099 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3100 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3101 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3102 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3103
3104 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3105 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3106 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3107
3108 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3109 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3110 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003111 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3112 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3113 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003114
3115 Example:
3116 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3117
3118 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003119 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003120
3121
3122capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003123 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3125 no | yes | yes | no
3126 Arguments :
3127 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003128 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003129 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3130 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3131 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3132
3133 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3134 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3135 it exceeds <length>.
3136
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003137 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3139 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003140 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3141 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3142 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3143 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003144 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003145 environments to find where the request came from.
3146
3147 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3148 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3149 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3150 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003151
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003152 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3153 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3154 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3155 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3156 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003157
3158 Example:
3159 capture request header Host len 15
3160 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003161 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003163 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003164 about logging.
3165
3166
3167capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003168 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3170 no | yes | yes | no
3171 Arguments :
3172 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003173 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003174 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3175 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3176 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3177
3178 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3179 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3180 it exceeds <length>.
3181
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003182 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003183 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3184 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3185 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003186 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3187 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3188 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3189 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003190
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003191 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3192 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3193 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3194 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3195 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003196
3197 Example:
3198 capture response header Content-length len 9
3199 capture response header Location len 15
3200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003201 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003202 about logging.
3203
3204
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003205clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003206 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3208 yes | yes | yes | no
3209 Arguments :
3210 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3211 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3212 as explained at the top of this document.
3213
3214 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3215 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3216 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3217 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3218 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3219 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3220 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3221 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003222 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003223 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003224 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003225
3226 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3227 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3228 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3229 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3230 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3231 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3232
3233 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3234 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3235
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003236 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3237 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003239compression algo <algorithm> ...
3240compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003241compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003242 Enable HTTP compression.
3243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3244 yes | yes | yes | yes
3245 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003246 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3247 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3248 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3249
3250 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003251 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3252 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3253 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003254
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003255 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003256 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003257
3258 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3259 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3260 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3261 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3262 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003263 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003264
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003265 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3266 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3267 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3268 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3269 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3270 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3271 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003272 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003273
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003274 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003275 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003276 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3277 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3278 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3279 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3280 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003281
3282 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3283 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3284 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3285 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3286 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003287 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3288 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3289 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3290 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3291 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003292 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3293 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003294
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003295 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003296 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3297 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivotto5380be22021-03-29 12:41:40 +02003298 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003299 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003300 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3301 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3302 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3303 "multipart"
3304 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3305 header
3306 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3307 and later
3308 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3309 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003310 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003311
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003312 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003313
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003314 Examples :
3315 compression algo gzip
3316 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003317
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003318
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003319contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003320 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3322 yes | no | yes | yes
3323 Arguments :
3324 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3325 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3326 as explained at the top of this document.
3327
3328 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003329 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003330 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003332 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3333 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3334 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3335
3336 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3337 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3338 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3339 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3340 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3341 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3342
3343 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3344 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3345 instead.
3346
3347 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3348 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3349
3350
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003351cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003352 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3353 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003354 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003355 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3357 yes | no | yes | yes
3358 Arguments :
3359 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3360 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3361 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3362 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3363 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3364 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003365 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003366 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3367 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3368
3369 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3370 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3371 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3372 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3373 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3374 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003375 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3376 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003377 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003378 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3379 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003380
3381 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003382 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003383
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003384 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003385 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003386 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003387 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003388 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3389 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3390 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3391 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3392 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3393 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3394 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003395
3396 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3397 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3398 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3399 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3400 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3401 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3402 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3403 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3404 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003405 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003406 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3407 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3408 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003409
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003410 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3411 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3412 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003413 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3414 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3415 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3416 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003417 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3418 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3419 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003420
3421 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3422 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3423 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3424 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3425 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3426 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3427 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3428 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3429 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3430
3431 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3432 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3433 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3434 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3435 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3436 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3437 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3438 persistence cookie in the cache.
3439 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3440
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003441 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3442 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3443 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3444 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3445 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003446 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003447 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3448 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3449 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3450 they logout.
3451
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003452 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3453 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3454 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3455 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3456
3457 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3458 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3459 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3460 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3461 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3462 this attribute.
3463
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003464 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003465 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003466 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3467 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3468 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3469 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3470 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3471 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003472
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003473 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3474 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3475 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3476 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3477 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3478 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3479 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3480 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003481 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003482 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3483 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3484 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3485 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3486 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3487 the site.
3488
3489 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3490 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3491 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3492 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3493 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3494 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3495 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3496 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3497 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3498 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3499 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3500 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3501 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003502 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003503 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3504 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3505
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003506 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3507 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3508 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3509 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3510 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3511 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3512
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003513 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3514 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3515 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3516 repeated.
3517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003518 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3519 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3520 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3521 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003522
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003523 Examples :
3524 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3525 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3526 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003527 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003528
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003529 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003530
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003531
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003532declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3533 Declares a capture slot.
3534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3535 no | yes | yes | no
3536 Arguments:
3537 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3538
3539 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3540 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3541 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3542 for use in the response.
3543
3544 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003545 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003546 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3547
3548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003549default-server [param*]
3550 Change default options for a server in a backend
3551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3552 yes | no | yes | yes
3553 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003554 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3555 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3556 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3557 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003558
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003559 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003560 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3561
3562 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003563
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003564
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003565default_backend <backend>
3566 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3568 yes | yes | yes | no
3569 Arguments :
3570 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3571
3572 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3573 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3574 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3575 will catch all undetermined requests.
3576
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003577 Example :
3578
3579 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3580 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3581 default_backend dynamic
3582
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003583 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003584
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003585
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003586description <string>
3587 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3589 no | yes | yes | yes
3590 Arguments : string
3591
3592 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3593 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3594 it describes.
3595 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3596
3597
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003598disabled
3599 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3601 yes | yes | yes | yes
3602 Arguments : none
3603
3604 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3605 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3606 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3607 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3608 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3609 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3610 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3611
3612 See also : "enabled"
3613
3614
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003615dispatch <address>:<port>
3616 Set a default server address
3617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3618 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003619 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003620
3621 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3622 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3623 during start-up.
3624
3625 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3626 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3627 possible with normal servers.
3628
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003629 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003630 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3631 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3632 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3633 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3634
3635 See also : "server"
3636
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003637
3638dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3639 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3641 yes | no | yes | yes
3642 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3643
3644 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003645 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003646 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3647 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003648 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003649 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003650
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003651enabled
3652 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3654 yes | yes | yes | yes
3655 Arguments : none
3656
3657 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3658 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3659
3660 See also : "disabled"
3661
3662
3663errorfile <code> <file>
3664 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3666 yes | yes | yes | yes
3667 Arguments :
3668 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Anthonin Bonnefoyb1e94072020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003669 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429,
3670 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003671
3672 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003673 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003674 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003675 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3676 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003677
3678 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3679 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3680 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3681
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003682 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3683
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003684 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3685 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3686 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3687 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3688
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003689 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3690 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003691 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003692 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3693 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3694 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3695
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003696 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3697 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3698 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003699 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003700 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3701
3702 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3703
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003704 Example :
3705 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003706 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003707 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3708 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3709
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003710
3711errorloc <code> <url>
3712errorloc302 <code> <url>
3713 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3715 yes | yes | yes | yes
3716 Arguments :
3717 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Anthonin Bonnefoyb1e94072020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003718 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429,
3719 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003720
3721 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3722 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3723 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3724 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003725 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003726
3727 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3728 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3729 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3730
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003731 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3732
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003733 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3734 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3735 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3736 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003737 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003738 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3739 request.
3740
3741 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3742
3743
3744errorloc303 <code> <url>
3745 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3747 yes | yes | yes | yes
3748 Arguments :
3749 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Anthonin Bonnefoyb1e94072020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003750 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429,
3751 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003752
3753 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3754 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3755 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3756 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003757 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003758
3759 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3760 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3761 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3762
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003763 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3764
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003765 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3766 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3767 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3768 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003769 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003770
3771 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3772
3773
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003774email-alert from <emailaddr>
3775 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003776 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003777 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3778 yes | yes | yes | yes
3779
3780 Arguments :
3781
3782 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3783
3784 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3785 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3786
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003787 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003788 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3789 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003790
3791
3792email-alert level <level>
3793 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3794 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3795 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3796 yes | yes | yes | yes
3797
3798 Arguments :
3799
3800 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3801 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3802 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3803
3804 By default level is alert
3805
3806 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3807 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3808 for the proxy.
3809
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003810 Alerts are sent when :
3811
3812 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3813 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3814 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3815 is notice or lower
3816 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3817 and a health check status update occurs
3818
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003819 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3820 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003821 section 3.6 about mailers.
3822
3823
3824email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3825 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3826 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3827 yes | yes | yes | yes
3828
3829 Arguments :
3830
3831 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3832
3833 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3834 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3835
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003836 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3837 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003838
3839
3840email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3841 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3842 mailers.
3843 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3844 yes | yes | yes | yes
3845
3846 Arguments :
3847
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003848 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003849
3850 By default the systems hostname is used.
3851
3852 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3853 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3854 for the proxy.
3855
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003856 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3857 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003858
3859
3860email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003861 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003862 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3863 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3864 yes | yes | yes | yes
3865
3866 Arguments :
3867
3868 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3869
3870 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3871 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3872
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003873 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003874 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3875
3876
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003877force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3878 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003880 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003881
3882 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3883 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3884 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3885 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3886 marked down for maintenance operations.
3887
3888 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3889 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3890 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3891 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3892 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3893 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3894 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3895 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3896 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3897
3898 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3899 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3900 is used.
3901
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003902 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003903 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003904
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003905
3906filter <name> [param*]
3907 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3909 no | yes | yes | yes
3910 Arguments :
3911 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3912 referenced in section 9.
3913
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003914 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003915 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003916 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3917 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003918
3919 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3920 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3921
3922 Example:
3923 listen
3924 bind *:80
3925
3926 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3927 filter compression
3928 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3929
3930 compression algo gzip
3931 compression offload
3932
3933 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3934
3935 See also : section 9.
3936
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003937
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003938fullconn <conns>
3939 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3941 yes | no | yes | yes
3942 Arguments :
3943 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3944 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3945
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003946 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003947 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003948 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003949 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3950 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3951 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3952 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3953 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003954 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003955
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003956 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3957 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003958 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3959 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3960 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003961
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003962 Example :
3963 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3964 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3965 # connections.
3966 backend dynamic
3967 fullconn 10000
3968 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3969 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3970
3971 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3972
3973
3974grace <time>
3975 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003977 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003978 Arguments :
3979 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3980 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3981 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3982
3983 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3984 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003985 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003986 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3987
3988 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3989 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3990 simplify it.
3991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003992
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003993hash-balance-factor <factor>
3994 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3996 yes | no | no | yes
3997 Arguments :
3998 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3999 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004000 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004001
4002 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4003 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4004 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4005 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4006 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4007 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4008 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4009
4010 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4011 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4012 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4013 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4014 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4015
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004016 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4017 consistent hashing mechanism.
4018
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004019 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4020
4021
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004022hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004023 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4025 yes | no | yes | yes
4026 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004027 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4028 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004029
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004030 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4031 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4032 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4033 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4034 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4035 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4036 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4037 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4038 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4039 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004040
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004041 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4042 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4043 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4044 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4045 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4046 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4047 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4048 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4049 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4050 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4051 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4052 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4053 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004054 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4055 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004056
4057 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4058
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004059 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004060 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4061 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4062 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004063 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4064 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4065 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004066
4067 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4068 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004069 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4070 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4071 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4072 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4073
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004074 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4075 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4076 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4077 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4078 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4079 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4080 parameter.
4081
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004082 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4083 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4084 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4085 used on strings.
4086
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004087 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4088
4089 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4090 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4091 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4092 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4093 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4094 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4095 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4096 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4097 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4098 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4099 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4100 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004101
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004102 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4103 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4104 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004105
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004106 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004107
4108
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004109http-check disable-on-404
4110 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004112 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004113 Arguments : none
4114
4115 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4116 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4117 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4118 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4119 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4120 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4121 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4122 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004123 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4124 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4125 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4126
4127 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4128
4129
4130http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004131 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004133 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004134 Arguments :
4135 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4136 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004137 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004138 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4139 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4140 details on the supported keywords.
4141
4142 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4143 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4144 with the usual backslash ('\').
4145
4146 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4147 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4148 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4149 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4150 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4151
4152 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004153 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004154 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4155 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4156 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4157
4158 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004159 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004160 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4161 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4162 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4163 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4164
4165 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004166 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004167 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4168 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4169 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4170 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4171 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004172 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004173 trace).
4174
4175 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004176 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004177 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4178 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4179 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4180 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4181 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004182 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004183
4184 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4185 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4186 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4187 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4188 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4189 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4190 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4191 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4192
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004193 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4194 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4195 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4196
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004197 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4198 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4199
4200 Examples :
4201 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004202 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004203
4204 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004205 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004206
4207 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004208 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004209
4210 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004211 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004212
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004213 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004214
4215
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004216http-check send [hdr <name> <value>]* [body <string>]
4217 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4218 health checks.
4219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4220 yes | no | yes | yes
4221 Arguments :
4222 hdr <name> <value> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4223 <name> and whose value is defined by <value> to the
4224 request sent during HTTP health checks.
4225
4226 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent
4227 sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4228 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added
4229 to the request.
4230
4231 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4232 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4233 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
4234 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. The old trick consisting to
4235 add headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
4236 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4237 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4238 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4239
4240 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect"
4241
4242
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004243http-check send-state
4244 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4246 yes | no | yes | yes
4247 Arguments : none
4248
4249 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4250 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4251 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4252 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4253 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4254
4255 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4256 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4257 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4258 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4259 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004260 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4261 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4262 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4263
4264 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4265 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4266 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4267
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004268 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4269 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4270 checked in multiple backends.
4271
4272 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4273 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4274
4275 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4276 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4277 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4278 one fails.
4279
4280 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4281 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4282 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4283
4284 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4285 server's queue.
4286
4287 Example of a header received by the application server :
4288 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4289 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4290
4291 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4292
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004293
4294http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004295 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4296
4297 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4298 no | yes | yes | yes
4299
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004300 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4301 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4302 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4303 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4304 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004305
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004306 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4307 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004309 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004310
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004311 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4312 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4313 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4314 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004316 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4317 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4318 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4319 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004321 Example:
4322 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4323 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4324 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004325
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004326 http-request allow if nagios
4327 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4328 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4329 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004331 Example:
4332 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4333 acl add path /addacl
4334 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004335
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004336 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004338 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4339 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004340
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004341 Example:
4342 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4343 acl setmap path /setmap
4344 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004345
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004346 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004347
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004348 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4349 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004351 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4352 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004353
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004354http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004356 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4357 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4358 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4359 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4360 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4361 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4362 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4363 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004365http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004366
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004367 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4368 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4369 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4370 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4371 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4372 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4373 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4374 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004376http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004378 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4379 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004380
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004381
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004382http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004384 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4385 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4386 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4387 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4388 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004389
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004390 Example:
4391 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4392 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004393
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004394http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004396 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004397
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004398http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4399 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004400
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004401 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4402 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4403 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4404 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4405 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4406 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4407 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4408 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4409 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004410
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004411 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4412 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4413 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann63b220d2020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004414 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4415
4416 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4417 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4418 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4419 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004420
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004421http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004422
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004423 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4424 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4425 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4426 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4427 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4428 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004429
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004430http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004431
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004432 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004433
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004434http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004435
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004436 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4437 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4438 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4439 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4440 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4441 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004442
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004443http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004444
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004445 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4446 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4447 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4448 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4449 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004450
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004451http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4452 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4453 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4454 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4455
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004456http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4457
4458 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4459 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4460 pointed by <resolvers>.
4461 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4462 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4463 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4464 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4465 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4466 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4467 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4468 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4469 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4470 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4471 to 0.0.0.0.
4472
4473 Example:
4474 resolvers mydns
4475 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4476 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4477 timeout retry 1s
4478 hold valid 10s
4479 hold nx 3s
4480 hold other 3s
4481 hold obsolete 0s
4482 accepted_payload_size 8192
4483
4484 frontend fe
4485 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4486 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4487 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4488
4489 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4490 # which mean DNS resolution error
4491 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4492
4493 default_backend be
4494
4495 backend b_503
4496 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4497 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4498 # 503 error page to end users
4499
4500 backend be
4501 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4502 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4503 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4504 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4505 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4506
4507 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4508 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4509
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004510http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4511
4512 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4513 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4514 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4515 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004516 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4517 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004518
4519 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4520
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004521http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004522
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004523 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4524 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4525 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4526 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4527 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004528
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004529http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004530
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004531 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4532 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4533 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4534 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004535
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004536http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4537 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004538
Ilya Shipitsin5c836fd2020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004539 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004540 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4541 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4542 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4543 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4544 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004545
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004546 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4547 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4548 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4549 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4550 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004551
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004552 Example:
4553 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4554
4555 # applied to:
4556 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4557
4558 # outputs:
4559 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4560
4561 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004562
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004563 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4564
4565 # applied to:
4566 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004567
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004568 # outputs:
4569 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004570
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004571http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4572 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4573
4574 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4575 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet99721282020-09-02 14:16:59 +02004576 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
4577 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
4578 query-string.
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004579
4580 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4581 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4582 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4583
4584 Example:
4585 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4586 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4587
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004588 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4589 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4590 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4591 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4592
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004593http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4594 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4595
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004596 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4597 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4598 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4599 against.
4600
4601 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4602 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4603 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004604
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004605 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4606 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4607 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4608 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4609 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4610 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4611 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4612 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4613 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004614 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4615 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004616
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004617 Example:
4618 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4619 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004620
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004621 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4622 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004623
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004624http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4625 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004626
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004627 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4628 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4629 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4630 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004631
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004632 Example:
4633 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004634
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004635 # applied to:
4636 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004637
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004638 # outputs:
4639 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004641http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4642http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004643
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004644 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4645 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4646 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004648http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004649
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004650 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4651 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4652 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004654http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004656 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4657 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4658 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4659 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4660 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004662 Arguments:
4663 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4664 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004665
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004666 Example:
4667 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4668 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004669
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004670 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4671 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004672
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004673http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004674
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004675 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4676 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4677 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004678
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004679 Arguments:
4680 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4681 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004682
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004683 Example:
4684 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4685 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004686
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004687 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4688 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4689 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004691http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004693 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4694 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4695 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4696 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4697 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004698
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004699 Example:
4700 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4701 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4702 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4703 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4704 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4705 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4706 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4707 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4708 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004709
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004710http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004711
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004712 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4713 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4714 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4715 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4716 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004717
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004718http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4719 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004720
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004721 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4722 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4723 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4724 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4725 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4726 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4727 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4728 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4729 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004730
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004731http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004732
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004733 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4734 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4735 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4736 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4737 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4738 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4739 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004740
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004741http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004742
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004743 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4744 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4745 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004746
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004747http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004748
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004749 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4750 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4751 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4752 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4753 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4754 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4755 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4756 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004757
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004758http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004759
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004760 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4761 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4762 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4763 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4764 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4765 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004766
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004767 Example :
4768 # prepend the host name before the path
4769 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004770
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004771http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004772
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004773 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4774 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4775 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4776 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4777 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004778
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004779http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004780
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004781 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4782 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4783 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4784 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4785 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4786 values have higher priority.
4787 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4788 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4789 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4790 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4791 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004792
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004793http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004794
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004795 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4796 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4797 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4798 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4799 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4800 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4801 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004802
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004803 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004804
4805 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004806 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4807 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004808
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004809http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4810 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4811 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4812 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004813 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
4814 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004815
4816 Arguments :
4817 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4818 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004819
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004820 See also "option forwardfor".
4821
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004822 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004823 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4824 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4825
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004826 # After the masking this will track connections
4827 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
4828 http-request track-sc0 src
4829
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004830 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4831 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4832
4833http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4834
4835 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4836 expression.
4837
4838 Arguments:
4839 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4840 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004841
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004842 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004843 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4844 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4845
4846 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4847 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4848 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4849
4850http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4851
4852 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4853 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4854 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4855 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4856 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4857 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4858 information from the request.
4859
4860 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4861
4862http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4863
4864 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4865 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4866 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4867 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4868 path and the query string.
4869 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4870
4871http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4872
4873 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4874 inline.
4875
4876 Arguments:
4877 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4878 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4879 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4880 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4881 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4882 (request and response)
4883 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4884 processing
4885 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4886 processing
4887 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4888 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4889 and '_'.
4890
4891 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4892 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004893
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004894 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004895 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004896
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004897http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4898 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004899
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004900 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4901 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4902 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4903 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4904 agent name must be used.
4905
4906 Arguments:
4907 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4908
4909 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4910 configuration.
4911
4912http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4913
4914 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4915 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4916 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4917 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4918 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4919 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4920 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4921 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4922 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4923 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4924 action.
4925 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4926 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4927 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4928 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4929 you fully understand how it works.
4930
4931http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4932
4933 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4934 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4935 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4936 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4937 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4938 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4939 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4940 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4941 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4942 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4943 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4944 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4945 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4946
4947http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4948http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4949http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4950
4951 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4952 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4953 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4954 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4955 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4956 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4957 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4958 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4959 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4960 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4961 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4962 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4963
4964 Arguments :
4965 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4966 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4967 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4968 select which table entry to update the counters.
4969
4970 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4971 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4972 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4973 that table until the session ends.
4974
4975 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4976 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4977 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4978 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4979 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4980 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4981 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4982 useful information.
4983
4984 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4985 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4986 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4987 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4988 checks that make use of it.
4989
4990http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4991
4992 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004993
4994 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004995 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004996
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004997http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4998
4999 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5000 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5001 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5002 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5003 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5004 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5005
5006 Arguments :
5007 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5008
5009 Example:
5010 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5011
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005012http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005014 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5015 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5016 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005017
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005018
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005019http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005020 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5021
5022 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5023 no | yes | yes | yes
5024
5025 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5026 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5027 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5028 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5029 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5030 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5031
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005032 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5033 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005034
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005035 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005036
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005037 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
5038 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
5039 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
5040 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005041
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005042 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
5043 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
5044 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
5045 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005046
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005047 Example:
5048 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005049
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005050 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005052 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5053 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005054
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005055 Example:
5056 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005057
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005058 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005059
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005060 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5061 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005062
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005063 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5064 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005065
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005066http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005067
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005068 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5069 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5070 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5071 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5072 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5073 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5074 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5075 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005076
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005077http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005078
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005079 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5080 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5081 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5082 example, or to pass some internal information.
5083 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5084 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5085 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005087http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005088
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005089 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5090 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005091
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005092http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005093
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005094 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005096http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005097
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005098 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5099 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5100 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5101 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5102 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5103 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5104 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005105
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005106 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5107 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5108 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5109 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5110 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann63b220d2020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005111
5112 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5113 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5114 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5115 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005116
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005117http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005118
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005119 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5120 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5121 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5122 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5123 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5124 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005125
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005126http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005127
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005128 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005129
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005130http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005131
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005132 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5133 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5134 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5135 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5136 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5137 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005138
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005139http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005140
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005141 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
5142 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005143
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005144http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005145
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005146 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5147 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5148 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5149 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5150 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5151 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005152
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005153http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5154 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005155
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005156 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5157 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005158
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005159 Example:
5160 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005161
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005162 # applied to:
5163 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005164
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005165 # outputs:
5166 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005167
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005168 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005169
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005170http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5171 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005172
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005173 This works like "http-response replace-value" except that it works on the
5174 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005175
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005176 Example:
5177 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005178
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005179 # applied to:
5180 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005181
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005182 # outputs:
5183 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005184
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005185http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5186http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005187
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005188 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5189 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5190 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005191
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005192http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005193
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005194 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
5195 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
5196 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005197
Christopher Fauletfd5a5e92021-08-12 09:32:07 +02005198http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5199 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005200
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005201 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5202 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5203 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5204 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5205 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005206
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005207 Arguments:
5208 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005209
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005210 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5211 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005212
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005213http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005214
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005215 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5216 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5217 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005218
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005219http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5220
5221 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5222 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5223 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5224 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5225 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5226
5227http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5228
5229 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5230 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5231 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5232 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5233 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5234 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5235 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5236 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5237 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5238
5239http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5240
5241 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5242 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5243 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5244 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5245 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5246 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5247 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5248
5249http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5250
5251 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5252 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5253 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5254 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5255 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5256 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5257 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5258 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5259
5260http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5261 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5262
5263 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5264 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5265 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5266 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005267
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005268 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005269 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5270 http-response set-status 431
5271 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5272 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005273
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005274http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005275
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005276 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5277 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5278 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5279 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5280 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5281 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5282 based on some information from the request.
5283
5284 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5285
5286http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5287
5288 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5289 inline.
5290
5291 Arguments:
5292 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5293 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5294 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5295 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5296 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5297 (request and response)
5298 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5299 processing
5300 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5301 processing
5302 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5303 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5304 and '_'.
5305
5306 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5307 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005308
5309 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005310 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005311
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005312http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005313
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005314 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5315 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5316 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5317 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5318 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5319 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5320 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5321 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5322 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5323 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5324 action.
5325 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5326 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5327 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5328 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5329 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005330
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005331http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5332http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5333http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005334
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005335 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5336 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5337 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5338 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5339 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5340 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5341
5342http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5343
5344 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5345 about <var-name>.
5346
5347 Example:
5348 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5349
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005350
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005351http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5352 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5353
5354 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5355 yes | no | yes | yes
5356
5357 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005358 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5359 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5360 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005361
5362 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5363
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005364 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5365 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5366 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5367 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5368 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5369 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5370 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5371 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5372 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5373 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005374
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005375 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5376 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5377 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5378 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5379 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5380 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5381 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5382 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005383
5384 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5385 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5386 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5387 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5388 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5389 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5390 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5391 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005392 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005393 downsides of rare connection failures.
5394
5395 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5396 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5397 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5398 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5399 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5400 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005401 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005402 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5403 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5404 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5405 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5406 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5407
5408 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005409 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5410 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5411 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005412
5413 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005414 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005415
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005416 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5417 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005418
Lukas Tribus79a56932019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005419 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005420
5421 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5422 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5423 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5424
5425 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5426
5427
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005428http-send-name-header [<header>]
5429 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005430 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5431 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005432 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005433 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5434
Willy Tarreaue0e32792019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005435 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5436 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5437 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5438 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5439 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5440 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5441 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5442 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5443 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5444 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5445 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5446 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5447 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5448 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5449 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5450 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005451
5452 See also : "server"
5453
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005454id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005455 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5457 no | yes | yes | yes
5458 Arguments : none
5459
5460 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5461 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5462 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005463
5464
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005465ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5466 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5467 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005468 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005469
5470 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5471 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5472 and running).
5473
5474 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5475 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5476 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005477 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005478 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5479
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005480 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5481 "unless" condition is met.
5482
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005483 Example:
5484 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5485 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5486 ignore-persist if url_static
5487
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005488 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5489
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005490load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5491 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5492 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5493 yes | no | yes | yes
5494
5495 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5496 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5497 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005498 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005499 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5500 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5501 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5502 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5503
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005504 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005505 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005506 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005507
5508 Arguments:
5509 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5510 named "server-state-file".
5511
5512 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5513 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5514 name is used as a file name.
5515
5516 none don't load any stat for this backend
5517
5518 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005519 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5520 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5521 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005522 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005523 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005524
5525 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5526 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5527
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005528 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005529
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005530 global
5531 stats socket /tmp/socket
5532 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005533
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005534 defaults
5535 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005536
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005537 backend bk
5538 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5539 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005540
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005541
5542 Then one can run :
5543
5544 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5545
5546 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5547
5548 1
5549 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5550 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5551 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5552
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005553 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005554
5555 global
5556 stats socket /tmp/socket
5557 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5558
5559 defaults
5560 load-server-state-from-file local
5561
5562 backend bk
5563 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5564 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5565
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005566
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005567 Then one can run :
5568
5569 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5570
5571 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5572
5573 1
5574 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5575 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5576 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5577
5578 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5579 "show servers state"
5580
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005581
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005582log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005583log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5584 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005585no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005586 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5588 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005589
5590 Prefix :
5591 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5592 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5593 prefix does not allow arguments.
5594
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005595 Arguments :
5596 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5597 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5598 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5599 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5600 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5601 parameter.
5602
5603 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5604 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5605
5606 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5607 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5608 standard syslog port).
5609
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005610 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5611 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5612 standard syslog port).
5613
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005614 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5615 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5616 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005617 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005618
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005619 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5620 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5621 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5622 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5623 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5624 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5625 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5626 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5627 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5628 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5629 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5630 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5631 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5632 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5633 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5634 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005635 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5636 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005637
5638 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5639 and "fd@2", see above.
5640
5641 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5642 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005643
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005644 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5645 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5646 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5647 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5648 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5649 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5650 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5651 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5652 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5653 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005654 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005655
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005656 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5657 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5658 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5659 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5660 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5661
5662 <sample_size>
5663 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5664 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5665 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5666 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5667 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5668
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005669 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5670 one of the following :
5671
5672 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5673 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5674
5675 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5676 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5677
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005678 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5679 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5680 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5681 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5682 systemd logger consumes.
5683
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005684 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5685 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5686 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5687 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5688
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005689 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5690
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005691 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5692 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5693 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5694
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005695 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5696 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5697 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5698 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005699
5700 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5701 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5702 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005703 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5704 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5705 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5706 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5707 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005708
5709 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5710
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005711 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5712 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5713 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005714
5715 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5716 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5717 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5718 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5719
5720 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5721 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005722
5723 Example :
5724 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005725 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5726 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5727 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005728 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5729 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005730 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005731
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005732
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005733log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005734 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5735 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5736 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005737
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005738 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5739 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5740 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5741 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5742 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005743
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005744 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5745 "option httplog" directives.
5746
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005747log-format-sd <string>
5748 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5749 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5750 yes | yes | yes | no
5751
5752 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5753 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5754 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5755 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5756 which covers the log format string in depth.
5757
5758 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5759 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5760
5761 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5762 log format to "rfc5424".
5763
5764 Example :
5765 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5766
5767
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005768log-tag <string>
5769 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5770 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5771 yes | yes | yes | yes
5772
5773 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5774 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5775 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5776 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5777 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5778 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5779 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5780 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5781 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005782
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005783max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5784 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5785 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5786 yes | no | yes | yes
5787
5788 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5789 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5790 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5791 servers.
5792
5793 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5794 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5795 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5796 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5797 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005798 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005799 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5800 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5801 picking a different server.
5802
5803 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5804 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5805 even if they have to be queued.
5806
5807 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5808 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5809
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005810max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5811 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5812 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5813 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005814
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005815maxconn <conns>
5816 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5818 yes | yes | yes | no
5819 Arguments :
5820 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5821 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5822 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5823 closes.
5824
5825 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5826 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5827 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5828 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005829 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5830 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5831 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5832 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005833
5834 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5835 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5836 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5837
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005838 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5839 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005840
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005841 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5842
5843
5844mode { tcp|http|health }
5845 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5847 yes | yes | yes | yes
5848 Arguments :
5849 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5850 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5851 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5852 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5853
5854 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5855 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5856 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5857 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5858 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5859
5860 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005861 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5862 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5863 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5864 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5865 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5866 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5867 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005868
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005869 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5870 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5871 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005872
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005873 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005874 defaults http_instances
5875 mode http
5876
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005877 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005878
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005879
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005880monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005881 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5883 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005884 Arguments :
5885 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5886 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005887 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005888 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5889 backend and its backup.
5890
5891 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5892 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5893 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5894 servers in a list of backends.
5895
5896 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5897 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5898 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5899 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5900 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5901 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5902 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005903 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5904 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005905
5906 Example:
5907 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005908 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005909 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5910 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5911 monitor-uri /site_alive
5912 monitor fail if site_dead
5913
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005914 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005915
5916
5917monitor-net <source>
5918 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5920 yes | yes | yes | no
5921 Arguments :
5922 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5923 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5924 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5925 followed by a mask.
5926
5927 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5928 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005929 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005930 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5931
5932 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5933 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5934 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5935 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005936 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5937 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5938 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005939
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005940 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5941 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5942 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5943 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5944 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5945 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005946
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005947 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5948 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005949
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005950 Example :
5951 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5952 frontend www
5953 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5954
5955 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5956
5957
5958monitor-uri <uri>
5959 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5961 yes | yes | yes | no
5962 Arguments :
5963 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5964 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5965
5966 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5967 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5968 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5969 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5970 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5971 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5972 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5973 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5974
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005975 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5976 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5977 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5978 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5979 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5980 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5981 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5982 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005983
5984 Example :
5985 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5986 frontend www
5987 mode http
5988 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5989
5990 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005992
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005993option abortonclose
5994no option abortonclose
5995 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5997 yes | no | yes | yes
5998 Arguments : none
5999
6000 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6001 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6002 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6003 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006004 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006005 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6006 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6007 encountered while delivering the response.
6008
6009 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6010 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6011 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6012 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6013 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6014 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006015 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006016 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006017 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006018 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6019 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6020 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6021
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006022 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6023 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006024 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6025 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6026 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6027 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6028 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6029 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006030 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006031
6032 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6033 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6034
6035 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6036
6037
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006038option accept-invalid-http-request
6039no option accept-invalid-http-request
6040 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6042 yes | yes | yes | no
6043 Arguments : none
6044
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006045 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006046 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006047 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006048 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6049 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6050 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6051 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6052 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006053 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6054 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6055 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6056 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006057 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006058 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006059 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6060 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6061 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006062
6063 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6064 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6065 been confirmed.
6066
6067 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6068 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006069 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6070 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006071 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6072
6073 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6074 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6075
6076 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6077 stats socket.
6078
6079
6080option accept-invalid-http-response
6081no option accept-invalid-http-response
6082 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6084 yes | no | yes | yes
6085 Arguments : none
6086
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006087 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006088 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006089 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006090 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6091 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6092 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6093 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6094 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006095 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6096 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6097 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006098
6099 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6100 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6101 been confirmed.
6102
6103 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6104 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6105 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6106 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6107
6108 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6109 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6110
6111 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6112 stats socket.
6113
6114
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006115option allbackups
6116no option allbackups
6117 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6119 yes | no | yes | yes
6120 Arguments : none
6121
6122 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6123 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6124 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6125 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6126 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6127 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6128 order between the backup servers anymore.
6129
6130 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6131 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6132
6133 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6134 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6135
6136
6137option checkcache
6138no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006139 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6141 yes | no | yes | yes
6142 Arguments : none
6143
6144 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6145 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006146 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006147 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6148 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006149 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006150
6151 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006152 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006153 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006154 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6155 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006156 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006157 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006158 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6159 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006160 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006161 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6162 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006163 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006164 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6165 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6166 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6167 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6168 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6169 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6170 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6171 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6172 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6173
6174 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006175 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006176 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006177 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006178 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
6179
6180 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6181 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006182 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006183 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006184
6185 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6186 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6187
6188
6189option clitcpka
6190no option clitcpka
6191 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6193 yes | yes | yes | no
6194 Arguments : none
6195
6196 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6197 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006198 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006199 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6200
6201 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6202 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6203 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6204 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6205
6206 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6207 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6208 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6209 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6210 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6211
6212 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6213
6214 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6215 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6216 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6217
6218 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6219 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6220
6221 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6222
6223
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006224option contstats
6225 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6227 yes | yes | yes | no
6228 Arguments : none
6229
6230 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6231 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6232 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6233 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006234 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6235 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6236 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6237 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6238 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006239
Christopher Fauletfe98e742020-06-02 17:33:56 +02006240option disable-h2-upgrade
6241no option disable-h2-upgrade
6242 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
6243 connection.
6244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6245 yes | yes | yes | no
6246 Arguments : none
6247
6248 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
6249 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
6250 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
6251 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
6252 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
6253 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
6254 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
6255 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
6256
6257 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6258 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006259
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006260option dontlog-normal
6261no option dontlog-normal
6262 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6264 yes | yes | yes | no
6265 Arguments : none
6266
6267 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6268 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6269 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6270 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6271 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6272 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6273 logged.
6274
6275 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6276 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6277 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006279 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006280 logging.
6281
6282
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006283option dontlognull
6284no option dontlognull
6285 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6287 yes | yes | yes | no
6288 Arguments : none
6289
6290 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6291 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6292 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6293 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6294 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6295 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006296 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6297 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6298 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006299
6300 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006301 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006302 would not be logged.
6303
6304 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6305 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6306
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006307 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6308 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006309
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006310
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006311option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006312 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6314 yes | yes | yes | yes
6315 Arguments :
6316 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6317 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006318 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006319 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006320
6321 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6322 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6323 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6324 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6325 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6326 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6327 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006328 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6329 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6330 possible that the client has already brought one.
6331
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006332 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006333 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006334 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006335 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006336 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006337 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006338
6339 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6340 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6341 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6342 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6343 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6344 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6345 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6346
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006347 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6348 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6349 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6350 are under the control of the end-user.
6351
Christopher Faulet313fa092021-04-06 09:01:09 +02006352 Only IPv4 addresses are supported. "http-request add-header" or "http-request
6353 set-header" rules may be used to work around this limitation.
6354
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006355 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006356 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6357 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006358 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6359 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6360 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006361
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006362 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006363 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6364 frontend www
6365 mode http
6366 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6367
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006368 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6369 backend www
6370 mode http
6371 option forwardfor header X-Client
6372
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006373 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006374 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006375
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006376
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006377option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6378no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6379 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6381 yes | yes | yes | no
6382 Arguments : none
6383
6384 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6385 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6386 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6387 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6388 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6389 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6390 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6391
6392 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6393 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6394 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6395 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6396 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6397 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6398 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6399 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6400 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6401 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6402
6403 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6404
6405 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6406 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6407
6408 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6409 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6410
6411
6412option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6413no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6414 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6416 yes | no | yes | yes
6417 Arguments : none
6418
6419 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6420 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6421 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6422 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6423 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6424 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6425 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6426
6427 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6428 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6429 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6430 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6431 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6432 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6433 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6434 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6435 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6436 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6437
6438 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6439
6440 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6441 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6442
6443 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6444 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6445
6446
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006447option http-buffer-request
6448no option http-buffer-request
6449 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6451 yes | yes | yes | yes
6452 Arguments : none
6453
6454 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6455 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6456 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6457 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6458 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6459 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6460 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6461 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006462 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006463 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6464 default.
6465
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006466 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006467
6468
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006469option http-ignore-probes
6470no option http-ignore-probes
6471 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6473 yes | yes | yes | no
6474 Arguments : none
6475
6476 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6477 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6478 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6479 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6480 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6481 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6482 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6483 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6484 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006485 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6486 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006487 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6488
6489 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6490 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6491 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6492 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6493 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6494 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6495 are often the only way to detect them.
6496
6497 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6498 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6499
6500 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6501
6502
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006503option http-keep-alive
6504no option http-keep-alive
6505 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6507 yes | yes | yes | yes
6508 Arguments : none
6509
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006510 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6511 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006512 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6513 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6514 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6515 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6516 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006517
6518 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6519 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006520 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6521 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6522 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6523 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6524 situations where this option may be useful :
6525
6526 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006527 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006528
6529 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6530 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6531
6532 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6533 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6534 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6535 request.
6536
6537 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6538 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006539 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6540 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6541 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006542
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006543 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6544 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6545 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6546 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6547 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6548 not set.
6549
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006550 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006551 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6552 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006553
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006554 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006555 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006556 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006557
6558
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006559option http-no-delay
6560no option http-no-delay
6561 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6563 yes | yes | yes | yes
6564 Arguments : none
6565
6566 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6567 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6568 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6569 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6570 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6571 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6572 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6573 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6574 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6575 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6576 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6577 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6578 affected.
6579
6580 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6581 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6582 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6583 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6584 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6585 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6586 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6587 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6588 latency environments.
6589
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006590 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6591
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006592
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006593option http-pretend-keepalive
6594no option http-pretend-keepalive
6595 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006597 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006598 Arguments : none
6599
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006600 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006601 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6602 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6603 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6604 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6605 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6606 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6607 consider the response complete.
6608
6609 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6610 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6611 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6612 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006613 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006614 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6615
6616 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6617 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6618 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6619 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6620 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6621 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6622 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6623
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006624 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6625 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6626 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6627 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6628 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6629 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006630
6631 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6632 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6633
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006634 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006635 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006636
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006637
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006638option http-server-close
6639no option http-server-close
6640 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6642 yes | yes | yes | yes
6643 Arguments : none
6644
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006645 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6646 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6647 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6648 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006649 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6650 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6651 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6652 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6653 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6654 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6655 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6656 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6657 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6658 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6659 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006660
6661 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6662 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6663 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6664 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006665 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6666 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006667
6668 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6669 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006670 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6671 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6672 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006673
6674 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6675 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6676
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006677 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6678 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006679
6680
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006681option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6682no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6683 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006685 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006686 Arguments : none
6687
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006688 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6689 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6690 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6691
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006692 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6693 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6694 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6695 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006696 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006697
6698 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006699 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006700 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6701 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6702 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6703 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6704 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6705 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6706 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006707
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006708 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6709 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6710 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6711 backend.
6712
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006713 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6714 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6715
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006716 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6717 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006718
6719
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006720option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006721no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006722 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6724 yes | yes | yes | no
6725 Arguments : none
6726
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006727 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006728 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6729 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6730 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6731 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6732 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6733 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6734
6735 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6736 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006737 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6738 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6739 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006740
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006741 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6742 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6743 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6744 front of an existing proxy.
6745
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006746 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6747
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006748 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006749
6750
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006751option http-use-htx
6752no option http-use-htx
6753 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6755 yes | yes | yes | yes
6756 Arguments : none
6757
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006758 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006759 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006760 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6761 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6762 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6763 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6764 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006765
6766 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6767 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6768 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6769 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006770 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6771 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6772 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6773 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006774
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006775 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6776 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6777 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6778 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6779 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006780
6781 See also : "mode http"
6782
6783
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006784option httpchk
6785option httpchk <uri>
6786option httpchk <method> <uri>
6787option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6788 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6790 yes | no | yes | yes
6791 Arguments :
6792 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6793 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6794 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6795 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6796 ones.
6797
6798 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6799 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6800 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6801
6802 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6803 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6804 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006805 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006806
6807 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6808 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6809 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6810 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6811 the lack of any response.
6812
6813 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6814
6815 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6816 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6817 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6818
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006819 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
6820 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
6821 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
6822 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
6823
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006824 Examples :
6825 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6826 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6827 backend https_relay
6828 mode tcp
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006829 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
6830 http-check send hdr Host www
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006831 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6832
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006833 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6834 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6835 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006836
6837
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006838option httpclose
6839no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006840 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6842 yes | yes | yes | yes
6843 Arguments : none
6844
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006845 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6846 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6847 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6848 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006849 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006850
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006851 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6852 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006853 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006854 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6855 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006856
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006857 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6858 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6859 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006860
6861 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6862 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006863 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006864 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6865 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6866 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006867
6868 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6869 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6870
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006871 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006872
6873
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006874option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006875 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006877 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006878 Arguments :
6879 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6880 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6881 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006882 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006883 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006884
6885 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6886 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6887 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6888 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6889 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6890 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6891 ports.
6892
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006893 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6894 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006895
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006896 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6897
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006898 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006899
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006900
6901option http_proxy
6902no option http_proxy
6903 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6905 yes | yes | yes | yes
6906 Arguments : none
6907
6908 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6909 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6910 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6911 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6912 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6913
6914 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6915 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006916 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6917 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006918
6919 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6920 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6921
6922 Example :
6923 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6924 backend direct_forward
6925 option httpclose
6926 option http_proxy
6927
6928 See also : "option httpclose"
6929
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006930
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006931option independent-streams
6932no option independent-streams
6933 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6935 yes | yes | yes | yes
6936 Arguments : none
6937
6938 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6939 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6940 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6941 receive data or not.
6942
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006943 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006944 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6945 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6946 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6947 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6948 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6949 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6950 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6951 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6952 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6953 socket buffers.
6954
6955 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6956 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6957 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6958 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6959 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6960
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006961 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006962 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6963 deprecated.
6964
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006965 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006966
6967
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006968option ldap-check
6969 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6971 yes | no | yes | yes
6972 Arguments : none
6973
6974 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6975 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6976 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6977 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6978
6979 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6980 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6981
6982 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6983 configure it.
6984
6985 Example :
6986 option ldap-check
6987
6988 See also : "option httpchk"
6989
6990
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006991option external-check
6992 Use external processes for server health checks
6993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6994 yes | no | yes | yes
6995
6996 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6997 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6998 command".
6999
7000 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7001
7002 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7003
7004
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007005option log-health-checks
7006no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007007 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7009 yes | no | yes | yes
7010 Arguments : none
7011
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007012 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7013 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7014 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007015
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007016 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7017 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7018 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7019 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7020 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7021
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007022 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007023 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007024
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007025 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7026 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7027 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007028
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007029
7030option log-separate-errors
7031no option log-separate-errors
7032 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7034 yes | yes | yes | no
7035 Arguments : none
7036
7037 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7038 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7039 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7040 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7041 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7042 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7043 provides very important information.
7044
7045 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7046 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7047 error logs.
7048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007049 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007050 logging.
7051
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007052
7053option logasap
7054no option logasap
Jerome Magnina1d4a732020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007055 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7057 yes | yes | yes | no
7058 Arguments : none
7059
Jerome Magnina1d4a732020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007060 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7061 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7062 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7063 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7064
7065 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7066 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7067 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7068 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7069 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
7070 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transfered
7071 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7072 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7073 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7074 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
7075 transfered.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007076
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007077 Examples :
7078 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7079 mode http
7080 option httplog
7081 option logasap
7082 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7083
7084 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7085 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7086 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7087 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7088
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007089 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007090 logging.
7091
7092
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007093option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007094 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7096 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007097 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007098 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7099 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007100 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007101
7102 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7103 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007104 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007105 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackcc690342021-07-01 12:09:32 +10007106 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
7107 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
7108 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007109
Daniel Blackcc690342021-07-01 12:09:32 +10007110 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
7111 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
7112 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007113
7114 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007115 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007116 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7117 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7118 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7119 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7120 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7121 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7122 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7123
7124 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7125 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007126
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007127 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007128
7129 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7130 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7131 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7132 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007133 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7134 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007135
7136 See also: "option httpchk"
7137
7138
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007139option nolinger
7140no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007141 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007142 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7143 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007144 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007145
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007146 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007147 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7148 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7149 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7150 connections.
7151
7152 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7153 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7154 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7155 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7156 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7157 this too.
7158
7159 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7160 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7161 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7162
7163 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7164 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7165 for servers.
7166
7167 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7168 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7169
7170
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007171option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7172 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7174 yes | yes | yes | yes
7175 Arguments :
7176 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7177 matching <network>
7178 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7179 header name.
7180
7181 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7182 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7183 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7184 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7185 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7186 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7187 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7188 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7189 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7190 possible that the client has already brought one.
7191
7192 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7193 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7194 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7195 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7196 header and requires different one.
7197
7198 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7199 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7200 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7201 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7202 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7203 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7204 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7205
Christopher Faulet313fa092021-04-06 09:01:09 +02007206 Only IPv4 addresses are supported. "http-request add-header" or "http-request
7207 set-header" rules may be used to work around this limitation.
7208
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007209 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7210 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7211 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7212 both are defined.
7213
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007214 Examples :
7215 # Original Destination address
7216 frontend www
7217 mode http
7218 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7219
7220 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7221 backend www
7222 mode http
7223 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7224
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007225 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007226
7227
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007228option persist
7229no option persist
7230 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7231 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7232 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007233 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007234
7235 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7236 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7237 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7238 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7239 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7240 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7241 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7242 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7243 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7244 redirected to another valid server.
7245
7246 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7247 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7248
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007249 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007250
7251
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007252option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7253 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7255 yes | no | yes | yes
7256 Arguments :
7257 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7258 PostgreSQL server.
7259
7260 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7261 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7262 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7263 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7264
7265 See also: "option httpchk"
7266
7267
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007268option prefer-last-server
7269no option prefer-last-server
7270 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7271 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7272 yes | no | yes | yes
7273 Arguments : none
7274
7275 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7276 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7277 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7278 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7279 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7280 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7281 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7282 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7283 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007284 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7285 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007286 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7287 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7288 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007289 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7290 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7291 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007292
7293 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7294 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7295
7296 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7297
7298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007299option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007300option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007301no option redispatch
7302 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7303 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7304 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007305 Arguments :
7306 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7307 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7308 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007309 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007310 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007311 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007312 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7313 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7314 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7315
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007316
7317 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7318 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7319 be able to access the service anymore.
7320
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007321 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7322 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007323
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007324 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007325 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7326 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007327
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007328 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
7329 "redisp" keywords.
7330
7331 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7332 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7333
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007334 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007335
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007336
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007337option redis-check
7338 Use redis health checks for server testing
7339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7340 yes | no | yes | yes
7341 Arguments : none
7342
7343 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7344 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7345 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7346 find the "+PONG" response message.
7347
7348 Example :
7349 option redis-check
7350
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007351 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007352
7353
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007354option smtpchk
7355option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7356 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7358 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007359 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007360 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007361 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007362 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7363
7364 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7365 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7366 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7367
7368 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7369 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7370 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7371 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7372 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7373 dead server.
7374
7375 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7376 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007377 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007378 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7379
7380 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7381 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7382 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7383 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007384 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007385
7386 Example :
7387 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7388
7389 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7390
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007391
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007392option socket-stats
7393no option socket-stats
7394
7395 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7397 yes | yes | yes | no
7398
7399 Arguments : none
7400
7401
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007402option splice-auto
7403no option splice-auto
7404 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7406 yes | yes | yes | yes
7407 Arguments : none
7408
7409 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7410 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007411 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007412 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007413 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007414 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7415 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7416 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7417 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7418
7419 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7420 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7421 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7422 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7423 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7424 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7425 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7426 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7427 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7428 keyword.
7429
7430 Example :
7431 option splice-auto
7432
7433 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7434 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7435
7436 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7437 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7438
7439
7440option splice-request
7441no option splice-request
7442 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7444 yes | yes | yes | yes
7445 Arguments : none
7446
7447 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007448 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007449 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7450 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7451 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7452 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7453
7454 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7455
7456 Example :
7457 option splice-request
7458
7459 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7460 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7461
7462 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7463 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7464
7465
7466option splice-response
7467no option splice-response
7468 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7470 yes | yes | yes | yes
7471 Arguments : none
7472
7473 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007474 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007475 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7476 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7477 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7478 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7479
7480 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7481
7482 Example :
7483 option splice-response
7484
7485 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7486 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7487
7488 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7489 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7490
7491
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007492option spop-check
7493 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7495 no | no | no | yes
7496 Arguments : none
7497
7498 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7499 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7500 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7501 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7502
7503 Example :
7504 option spop-check
7505
7506 See also : "option httpchk"
7507
7508
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007509option srvtcpka
7510no option srvtcpka
7511 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7513 yes | no | yes | yes
7514 Arguments : none
7515
7516 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7517 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007518 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007519 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7520
7521 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7522 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7523 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7524 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7525
7526 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7527 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7528 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7529 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7530 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7531
7532 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7533
7534 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7535 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7536 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7537
7538 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7539 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7540
7541 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7542
7543
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007544option ssl-hello-chk
7545 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7547 yes | no | yes | yes
7548 Arguments : none
7549
7550 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7551 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7552 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7553 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7554 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7555 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7556 hello message.
7557
7558 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7559 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7560 messages, which is appreciable.
7561
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007562 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7563 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7564 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007565
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007566 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7567
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007568
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007569option tcp-check
7570 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7571 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7572 yes | no | yes | yes
7573
7574 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7575 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7576
7577 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7578 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7579 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7580
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007581 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007582 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7583 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7584 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7585 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7586 only.
7587
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007588 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007589 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7590 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7591 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7592 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7593
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007594 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007595 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7596 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007597 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007598 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7599 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7600 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7601 the respective protocols.
7602 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007603 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007604
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007605 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7606 script.
7607
7608 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7609 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7610 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7611 The "comment" is of course optional.
7612
7613
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007614 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007615 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007616 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007617 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007618
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007619 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007620 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007621 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007622
7623 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7624 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007625 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007626 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007627 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007628 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007629 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007630 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007631 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7632 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007633 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007634 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7635 tcp-check expect string +OK
7636
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007637 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007638 (send many headers before analyzing)
7639 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007640 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007641 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7642 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7643 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7644 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007645 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007646
7647
7648 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7649
7650
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007651option tcp-smart-accept
7652no option tcp-smart-accept
7653 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7655 yes | yes | yes | no
7656 Arguments : none
7657
7658 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7659 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7660 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7661 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7662 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7663 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7664
7665 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7666 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7667 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7668 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7669
7670 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7671 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7672 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007673 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007674
7675 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7676 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7677 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7678
7679 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7680 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7681 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7682
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007683 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7684
7685
7686option tcp-smart-connect
7687no option tcp-smart-connect
7688 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7690 yes | no | yes | yes
7691 Arguments : none
7692
7693 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7694 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7695 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7696 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7697 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7698
7699 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7700 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7701 complex.
7702
7703 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7704 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7705 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7706
7707 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7708 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7709
7710 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7711
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007712
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007713option tcpka
7714 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7716 yes | yes | yes | yes
7717 Arguments : none
7718
7719 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7720 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007721 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007722 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7723
7724 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7725 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7726 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7727 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7728
7729 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7730 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7731 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7732 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7733 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7734
7735 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7736
7737 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7738 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7739 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7740 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7741 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7742 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7743 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7744 backends.
7745
7746 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7747
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007748
7749option tcplog
7750 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007752 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007753 Arguments : none
7754
7755 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7756 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7757 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7758 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7759 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7760 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7761 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7762 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7763
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007764 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007766 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007767
7768
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007769option transparent
7770no option transparent
7771 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007773 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007774 Arguments : none
7775
7776 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7777 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7778 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7779 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7780 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7781 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7782 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7783 appropriate server.
7784
7785 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7786 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7787
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007788 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007789 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007790
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007791
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007792external-check command <command>
7793 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7795 yes | no | yes | yes
7796
7797 Arguments :
7798 <command> is the external command to run
7799
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007800 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7801
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007802 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007803
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007804 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7805 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7806 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7807 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7808 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7809 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007810
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007811 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7812
7813 Environment variables :
7814 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7815 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7816
7817 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7818
7819 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7820
7821 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7822 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7823 for a UNIX socket).
7824
7825 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7826
7827 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7828
7829 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7830
7831 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7832
7833 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7834
7835 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7836 socket).
7837
7838 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7839 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7840
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007841 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7842
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007843 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7844 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7845 failed.
7846
7847 Example :
7848 external-check command /bin/true
7849
7850 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7851
7852
7853external-check path <path>
7854 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7856 yes | no | yes | yes
7857
7858 Arguments :
7859 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7860
7861 The default path is "".
7862
7863 Example :
7864 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7865
7866 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7867 "external-check command"
7868
7869
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007870persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007871persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007872 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7874 yes | no | yes | yes
7875 Arguments :
7876 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007877 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7878 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007879
7880 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7881 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007882 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007883 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7884 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7885 forwarded to this server.
7886
7887 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7888 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7889 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007890 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007891 a single "listen" section.
7892
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007893 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7894 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7895 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7896
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007897 Example :
7898 listen tse-farm
7899 bind :3389
7900 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7901 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7902 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7903 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7904 persist rdp-cookie
7905 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007906 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007907 balance rdp-cookie
7908 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7909 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7910
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007911 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7912 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007913
7914
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007915rate-limit sessions <rate>
7916 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7918 yes | yes | yes | no
7919 Arguments :
7920 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7921 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7922
7923 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7924 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7925 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7926 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7927 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7928 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7929
7930 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7931 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7932 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7933 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7934
7935 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7936 listen smtp
7937 mode tcp
7938 bind :25
7939 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007940 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007941
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007942 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7943 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7944 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007945
7946 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7947
7948
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007949redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7950redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7951redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007952 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7954 no | yes | yes | yes
7955
7956 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007957 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007958
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007959 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007960 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007961 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7962 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7963 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007964
7965 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7966 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7967 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7968 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7969 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007970 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7971 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7972 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7973 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007974
7975 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7976 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7977 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7978 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7979 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7980 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007981 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007982 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007983 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7984 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7985 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007986
7987 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007988 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7989 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7990 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007991 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007992 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7993 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7994 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7995 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007996
7997 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007998 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007999
8000 - "drop-query"
8001 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8002 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8003 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8004 with a location-type redirect.
8005
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008006 - "append-slash"
8007 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8008 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8009 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8010 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8011
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008012 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8013 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8014 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8015 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8016 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8017 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8018 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8019
8020 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8021 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8022 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8023 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8024 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8025 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8026 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008027
8028 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8029 acl clear dst_port 80
8030 acl secure dst_port 8080
8031 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008032 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008033 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008034 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8035
8036 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008037 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8038 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8039 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008040 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008041
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008042 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8043 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8044 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8045
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008046 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008047 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008048
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008049 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008050 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8051 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8052 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008053
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008054 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008055
8056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008057redisp (deprecated)
8058redispatch (deprecated)
8059 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8060 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8061 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008062 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008063
8064 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8065 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8066 be able to access the service anymore.
8067
8068 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
8069 redistribute them to a working server.
8070
8071 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
8072 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8073 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008074
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008075 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
8076 "option redispatch" instead.
8077
8078 See also : "option redispatch"
8079
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008080
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008081reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008082 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
8083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8084 no | yes | yes | yes
8085 Arguments :
8086 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8087 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008088 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008089
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01008090 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8091 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8092
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008093 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8094 the last header of an HTTP request.
8095
8096 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8097 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8098 responses.
8099
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01008100 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
8101 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
8102 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
8103
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008104 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
8105 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008106
8107
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008108reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8109reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008110 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8112 no | yes | yes | yes
8113 Arguments :
8114 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8115 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8116 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8117 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8118 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8119 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
8120 ignores case.
8121
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008122 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8123 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8124
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008125 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8126 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
8127 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8128 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008129 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008130
8131 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8132 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8133
8134 Example :
8135 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
8136 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8137 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8138
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008139 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
8140 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008141
8142
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008143reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8144reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008145 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
8146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8147 no | yes | yes | yes
8148 Arguments :
8149 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8150 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8151 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8152 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8153 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
8154 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
8155
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008156 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8157 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8158
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008159 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
8160 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
8161 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
8162 next servers.
8163
8164 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8165 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8166 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8167
8168 Example :
8169 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
8170 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
8171 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
8172
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008173 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
8174 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008175
8176
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008177reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8178reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008179 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8181 no | yes | yes | yes
8182 Arguments :
8183 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8184 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8185 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8186 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8187 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8188 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
8189 case.
8190
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008191 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8192 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8193
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008194 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8195 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
8196 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8197 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008198 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008199
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008200 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008201 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008202 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008203
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008204 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8205 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8206
8207 Example :
8208 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
8209 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8210 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8211
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008212 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8213 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008214
8215
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008216reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8217reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008218 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
8219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8220 no | yes | yes | yes
8221 Arguments :
8222 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8223 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8224 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8225 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8226 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8227 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
8228 case.
8229
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008230 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8231 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8232
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008233 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8234 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
8235 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
8236 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8237
8238 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8239 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8240
8241 Example :
8242 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
8243 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
8244 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8245 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8246
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008247 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8248 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008249
8250
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008251reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8252reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008253 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
8254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8255 no | yes | yes | yes
8256 Arguments :
8257 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8258 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8259 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8260 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8261 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
8262 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
8263
8264 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8265 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8266 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8267 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008268 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008269
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008270 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8271 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8272
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008273 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
8274 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
8275 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
8276
8277 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8278 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8279 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8280 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
8281 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8282
8283 Example :
8284 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008285 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008286 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
8287 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
8288
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008289 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
8290 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008291
8292
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008293reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8294reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008295 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
8296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8297 no | yes | yes | yes
8298 Arguments :
8299 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8300 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8301 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8302 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8303 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8304 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
8305 ignores case.
8306
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008307 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8308 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8309
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008310 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8311 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008312 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
8313 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
8314 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008315 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
8316 not set.
8317
8318 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
8319 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
8320 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
8321 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
8322 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
8323
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008324 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008325 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008326 # block all others.
8327 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
8328 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
8329
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008330 # block bad guys
8331 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
8332 reqitarpit . if badguys
8333
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008334 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
8335 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008336
8337
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008338retries <value>
8339 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8340 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8341 yes | no | yes | yes
8342 Arguments :
8343 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8344 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8345 default value is 3.
8346
8347 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8348 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8349 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8350
8351 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008352 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8353 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008354
8355 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8356 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8357
8358 See also : "option redispatch"
8359
8360
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008361retry-on [list of keywords]
8362 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8363 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8364 yes | no | yes | yes
8365 Arguments :
8366 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8367 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8368 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8369 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8370
8371 none never retry
8372
8373 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8374 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8375
8376 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8377 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8378 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8379 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8380 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8381 processing the request.
8382
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008383 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8384 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8385 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8386 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8387 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8388 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8389 overflow attack for example).
8390
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008391 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8392 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8393 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8394 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8395 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8396 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8397 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8398 amplify denial of service attacks.
8399
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008400 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8401 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8402 considered to be safe to retry.
8403
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008404 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8405 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8406 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8407 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8408
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008409 all-retryable-errors
8410 retry request for any error that are considered
8411 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8412 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8413 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8414
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008415 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8416 not cumulative.
8417
8418 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8419 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8420 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8421 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8422
8423 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8424 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8425 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8426 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8427 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8428 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8429 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8430 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8431 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8432 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8433 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8434 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8435
8436 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8437 should not use this directive.
8438
8439 The default is "conn-failure".
8440
8441 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8442
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008443rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008444 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8446 no | yes | yes | yes
8447 Arguments :
8448 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8449 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008450 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008451
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008452 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8453 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8454
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008455 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8456 the last header of an HTTP response.
8457
8458 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8459 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8460 responses.
8461
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008462 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8463 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008464
8465
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008466rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8467rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008468 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8470 no | yes | yes | yes
8471 Arguments :
8472 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8473 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8474 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8475 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8476 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8477 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8478 ignores case.
8479
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008480 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8481 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8482
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008483 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8484 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008485 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008486 client.
8487
8488 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8489 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8490 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8491
8492 Example :
8493 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008494 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008495
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008496 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8497 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008498
8499
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008500rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8501rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008502 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8504 no | yes | yes | yes
8505 Arguments :
8506 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8507 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8508 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8509 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8510 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8511 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8512 ignores case.
8513
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008514 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8515 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8516
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008517 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8518 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8519 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8520 case-sensitive.
8521
8522 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008523 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8524 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8525 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008526
8527 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8528 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8529
8530 Example :
8531 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8532 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8533
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008534 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8535 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008536
8537
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008538rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8539rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008540 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8542 no | yes | yes | yes
8543 Arguments :
8544 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8545 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8546 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8547 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8548 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8549 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8550 ignores case.
8551
8552 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8553 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8554 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8555 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008556 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008557
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008558 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8559 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8560
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008561 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8562 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8563 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8564
8565 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8566 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8567 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8568 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8569 are not case-sensitive.
8570
8571 Example :
8572 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8573 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8574
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008575 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8576 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008577
8578
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008579server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008580 Declare a server in a backend
8581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8582 no | no | yes | yes
8583 Arguments :
8584 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008585 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008586 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008587
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008588 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8589 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8590 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8591 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008592 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8593 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8594 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8595 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8596 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008597 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8598 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8599 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8600 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8601 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8602 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8603 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008604 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008605 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8606 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8607 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8608 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8609 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8610 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008611 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8612 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008613 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8614 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008615
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008616 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008617 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8618 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8619 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8620 adding this value to the client's port.
8621
8622 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8623 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008624 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008625
8626 Examples :
8627 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8628 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008629 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008630 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8631 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8632 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008633
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008634 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8635 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8636 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8637 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8638 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8639
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008640 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8641 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008642
Christopher Fauletea1300f2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01008643server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008644 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Fauletea1300f2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01008645 this backend.
8646 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8647 no | no | yes | yes
8648
8649 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
8650 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
8651 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
8652 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
8653 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008654
8655 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8656 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8657
8658 global
8659 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8660
Willy Tarreau750bb0c2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008661 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008662 load-server-state-from-file
8663
Christopher Fauletea1300f2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01008664 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008665 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008666
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008667server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8668 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8669 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8671 no | no | yes | yes
8672
8673 Arguments:
8674 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8675
8676 <num | range>
8677 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8678 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8679 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8680 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8681
8682 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8683
8684 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8685
8686 <params*>
8687 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8688 keyword.
8689
8690 Examples:
8691 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8692 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8693 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8694
8695 # or
8696 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8697
8698 # would be equivalent to:
8699 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8700 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8701 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8702
8703
8704
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008705source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008706source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008707source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008708 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8710 yes | no | yes | yes
8711 Arguments :
8712 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8713 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008714
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008715 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008716 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8717 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8718 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8719 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8720 supported prefixes are :
8721 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8722 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8723 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008724 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008725 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8726 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008727
8728 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8729 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008730 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8731 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8732 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008733
8734 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8735 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8736 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8737 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8738 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8739 <addr>.
8740
8741 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8742 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8743 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8744 port.
8745
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008746 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8747 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8748 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8749 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008750 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008751 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8752 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8753 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8754 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8755 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8756 HTTP header.
8757
8758 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8759 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008760 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008761 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8762 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8763 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8764 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8765 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8766 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8767 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8768
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008769 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8770 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8771 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8772 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8773 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8774 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8775
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008776 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8777 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8778 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8779 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8780
8781 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8782 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8783 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8784 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8785 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8786 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8787
8788 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8789 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8790 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8791 there are two methods :
8792
8793 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8794 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8795 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8796 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8797 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8798 of the client ranges may be used.
8799
8800 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8801 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8802 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8803 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8804 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8805 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8806 same session.
8807
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008808 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8809 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8810 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008811 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008812
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008813 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8814
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008815 Examples :
8816 backend private
8817 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8818 source 192.168.1.200
8819
8820 backend transparent_ssl1
8821 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8822 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8823
8824 backend transparent_ssl2
8825 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8826 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8827 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8828
8829 backend transparent_ssl3
8830 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8831 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8832 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8833
8834 backend transparent_smtp
8835 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8836 # with Tproxy version 4.
8837 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8838
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008839 backend transparent_http
8840 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8841 # proxy.
8842 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8843
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008844 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008845 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8846
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008847
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008848srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8849 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8851 yes | no | yes | yes
8852 Arguments :
8853 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8854 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8855 as explained at the top of this document.
8856
8857 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8858 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8859 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8860 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8861 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8862 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8863 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8864
8865 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8866 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8867 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8868 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8869 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008870 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008871 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008872 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008873
8874 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8875 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8876 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8877 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8878 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8879 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8880
8881 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8882 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8883
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008884 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8885 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008886
8887
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008888stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8889 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008891 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008892
8893 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8894 matched.
8895
8896 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8897 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8898
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008899 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8900 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008901 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008902
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008903 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8904 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8905 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8906 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008907
8908 Example :
8909 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8910 backend stats_localhost
8911 stats enable
8912 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8913
8914 Example :
8915 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8916 backend stats_auth
8917 stats enable
8918 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8919 stats admin if TRUE
8920
8921 Example :
8922 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8923 userlist stats-auth
8924 group admin users admin
8925 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8926 group readonly users haproxy
8927 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8928
8929 backend stats_auth
8930 stats enable
8931 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8932 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8933 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8934 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8935
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008936 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8937 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8938 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008939
8940
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008941stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8942 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008944 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008945 Arguments :
8946 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8947
8948 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8949
8950 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8951 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8952 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8953 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8954 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8955 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8956
8957 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8958 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8959 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008960 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008961
8962 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8963 report using "stats scope".
8964
8965 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8966 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8967 unobvious parameters.
8968
8969 Example :
8970 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8971 backend public_www
8972 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8973 stats enable
8974 stats hide-version
8975 stats scope .
8976 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008977 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008978 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8979 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8980
8981 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8982 backend private_monitoring
8983 stats enable
8984 stats uri /admin?stats
8985 stats refresh 5s
8986
8987 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8988
8989
8990stats enable
8991 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008993 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008994 Arguments : none
8995
8996 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8997 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8998 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8999 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9000 - stats auth : no authentication
9001 - stats scope : no restriction
9002
9003 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9004 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9005 unobvious parameters.
9006
9007 Example :
9008 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9009 backend public_www
9010 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9011 stats enable
9012 stats hide-version
9013 stats scope .
9014 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009015 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009016 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9017 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9018
9019 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9020 backend private_monitoring
9021 stats enable
9022 stats uri /admin?stats
9023 stats refresh 5s
9024
9025 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9026
9027
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009028stats hide-version
9029 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009031 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009032 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009033
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009034 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9035 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9036 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9037 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9038 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9039 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009040
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009041 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9042 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9043 unobvious parameters.
9044
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009045 Example :
9046 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9047 backend public_www
9048 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009049 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009050 stats hide-version
9051 stats scope .
9052 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009053 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009054 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9055 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009056
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009057 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9058 backend private_monitoring
9059 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009060 stats uri /admin?stats
9061 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009062
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009063 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009064
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009065
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009066stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9067 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9068 Access control for statistics
9069
9070 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9071 no | no | yes | yes
9072
9073 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9074 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9075 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9076 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9077 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9078 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9079
9080 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9081 instance.
9082
9083 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9084 about ACL usage.
9085
9086
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009087stats realm <realm>
9088 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009090 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009091 Arguments :
9092 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9093 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9094 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9095
9096 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9097 using a backslash ('\').
9098
9099 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9100 only related to authentication.
9101
9102 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9103 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9104 unobvious parameters.
9105
9106 Example :
9107 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9108 backend public_www
9109 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9110 stats enable
9111 stats hide-version
9112 stats scope .
9113 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009114 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009115 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9116 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9117
9118 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9119 backend private_monitoring
9120 stats enable
9121 stats uri /admin?stats
9122 stats refresh 5s
9123
9124 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9125
9126
9127stats refresh <delay>
9128 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009130 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009131 Arguments :
9132 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9133 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9134 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9135 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9136 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9137 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9138
9139 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9140 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9141 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9142 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9143
9144 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9145 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9146 unobvious parameters.
9147
9148 Example :
9149 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9150 backend public_www
9151 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9152 stats enable
9153 stats hide-version
9154 stats scope .
9155 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009156 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009157 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9158 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9159
9160 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9161 backend private_monitoring
9162 stats enable
9163 stats uri /admin?stats
9164 stats refresh 5s
9165
9166 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9167
9168
9169stats scope { <name> | "." }
9170 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009172 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009173 Arguments :
9174 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9175 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9176 section in which the statement appears.
9177
9178 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9179 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9180 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9181 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9182 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9183 exists.
9184
9185 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9186 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9187 unobvious parameters.
9188
9189 Example :
9190 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9191 backend public_www
9192 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9193 stats enable
9194 stats hide-version
9195 stats scope .
9196 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009197 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009198 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9199 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9200
9201 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9202 backend private_monitoring
9203 stats enable
9204 stats uri /admin?stats
9205 stats refresh 5s
9206
9207 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9208
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009209
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009210stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009211 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009213 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009214
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009215 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009216 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9217
9218 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9219 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9220
9221 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9222 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009223 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009224
9225 Example :
9226 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9227 backend private_monitoring
9228 stats enable
9229 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9230 stats uri /admin?stats
9231 stats refresh 5s
9232
9233 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9234 global section.
9235
9236
9237stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009238 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9240 yes | yes | yes | yes
9241 Arguments : none
9242
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009243 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009244 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9245 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9246 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9247 - IP (socket, server)
9248 - cookie (backend, server)
9249
9250 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9251 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009252 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009253
9254 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9255
9256
9257stats show-node [ <name> ]
9258 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009260 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009261 Arguments:
9262 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9263 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9264
9265 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9266 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009267 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009268
9269 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9270 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9271 unobvious parameters.
9272
9273 Example:
9274 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9275 backend private_monitoring
9276 stats enable
9277 stats show-node Europe-1
9278 stats uri /admin?stats
9279 stats refresh 5s
9280
9281 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9282 section.
9283
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009284
9285stats uri <prefix>
9286 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009288 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009289 Arguments :
9290 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9291 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9292 query string.
9293
9294 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9295 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9296 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9297 possible to reach it in the application.
9298
9299 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009300 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009301 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9302 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9303 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9304 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9305
9306 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9307 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9308 an address or a port to statistics only.
9309
9310 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9311 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9312 unobvious parameters.
9313
9314 Example :
9315 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9316 backend public_www
9317 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9318 stats enable
9319 stats hide-version
9320 stats scope .
9321 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009322 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009323 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9324 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9325
9326 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9327 backend private_monitoring
9328 stats enable
9329 stats uri /admin?stats
9330 stats refresh 5s
9331
9332 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9333
9334
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009335stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9336 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009338 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009339
9340 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009341 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009342 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009343 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009344 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9345
9346 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9347 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9348 the "stick-table" statement.
9349
9350 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9351 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9352 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9353 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9354 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9355
9356 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9357 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9358 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9359 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9360 transformation rules.
9361
9362 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9363 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9364 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9365 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9366 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9367 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9368 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9369
9370 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9371 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9372 ACL based conditions.
9373
9374 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9375 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9376 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9377 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9378
9379 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9380 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9381 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9382 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9383
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009384 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9385 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009386 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009387
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009388 Example :
9389 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9390 # last 30 minutes
9391 backend pop
9392 mode tcp
9393 balance roundrobin
9394 stick store-request src
9395 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9396 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9397 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9398
9399 backend smtp
9400 mode tcp
9401 balance roundrobin
9402 stick match src table pop
9403 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9404 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9405
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009406 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009407 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009408
9409
9410stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9411 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9413 no | no | yes | yes
9414
9415 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9416 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9417 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9418 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9419
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009420 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9421 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009422 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009423
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009424 Examples :
9425 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009426 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009427
9428 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9429 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9430 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9431
9432
9433 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9434 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9435 backend http
9436 mode http
9437 balance roundrobin
9438 stick on src table https
9439 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9440 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9441 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9442
9443 backend https
9444 mode tcp
9445 balance roundrobin
9446 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9447 stick on src
9448 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9449 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9450
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009451 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009452
9453
9454stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9455 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9457 no | no | yes | yes
9458
9459 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009460 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009461 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009462 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009463 server is selected.
9464
9465 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9466 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9467 the "stick-table" statement.
9468
9469 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9470 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9471 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9472 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9473 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9474 address.
9475
9476 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9477 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9478 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9479 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9480 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9481 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9482 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9483 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9484 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9485 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9486
9487 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9488 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9489 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9490 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9491 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9492 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9493 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9494
9495 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9496 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9497 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9498 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9499
9500 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9501 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9502 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9503 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9504 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9505 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009506 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9507 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9508 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9509 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9510 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9511 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009512
9513 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9514 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9515 the request.
9516
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009517 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9518 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009519 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009520
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009521 Example :
9522 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9523 # last 30 minutes
9524 backend pop
9525 mode tcp
9526 balance roundrobin
9527 stick store-request src
9528 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9529 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9530 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9531
9532 backend smtp
9533 mode tcp
9534 balance roundrobin
9535 stick match src table pop
9536 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9537 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9538
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009539 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009540 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009541
9542
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009543stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009544 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9545 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009546 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009548 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009549
9550 Arguments :
9551 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9552 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9553 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9554 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9555
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009556 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9557 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9558 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9559 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9560
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009561 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9562 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9563 instance.
9564
9565 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9566 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9567 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9568 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9569 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9570 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009571 to 32 characters.
9572
9573 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9574 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9575 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009576 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009577 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9578 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009579
9580 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009581 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9582 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009583 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9584 increase.
9585
9586 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009587 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9588 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9589 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009590
9591 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9592 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9593 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9594 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009595 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009596 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9597 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9598 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9599 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9600 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9601 parameter (see below).
9602
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009603 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9604 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9605 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9606 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9607 soft restart.
9608
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009609 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9610 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009611
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009612 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9613 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9614 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9615 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009616 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009617 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009618 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9619 if not expiration delay is specified.
9620
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009621 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9622 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9623 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9624 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009625 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9626 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9627 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9628 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9629 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9630 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9631 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9632 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9633 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9634 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9635 types and their arguments.
9636
9637 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9638 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9639 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9640 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9641
9642 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9643 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9644 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009645 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009646
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009647 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9648 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9649 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009650 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009651 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009652 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009653
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009654 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9655 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9656 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9657 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9658
9659 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9660 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9661 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9662 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9663 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9664 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9665
Emeric Brunf143ccf2021-07-01 18:34:48 +02009666 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9667 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9668 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9669 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
9670
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009671 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9672 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9673 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9674 they were received.
9675
9676 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9677 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9678 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9679 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9680 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9681
9682 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9683 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9684 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9685 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9686 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9687
9688 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9689 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9690 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9691
9692 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9693 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9694 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9695 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9696 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9697
9698 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9699 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9700 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9701 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9702 the client side.
9703
9704 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9705 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9706 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9707 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9708 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9709 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9710 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9711
9712 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9713 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9714 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9715 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9716 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9717 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009718 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009719
9720 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9721 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9722 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9723 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9724 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9725 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9726
9727 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009728 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009729 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9730 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9731
9732 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9733 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9734 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9735 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9736 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9737 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9738 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9739 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9740 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9741 recommended for better fairness.
9742
9743 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009744 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009745 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9746 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9747
9748 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9749 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9750 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9751 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9752 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9753 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9754 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9755 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9756 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9757 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009758
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009759 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9760 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009761 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9762 reference it.
9763
9764 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9765 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009766 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9767 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9768 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009769
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009770 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9771 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9772 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9773 something that can be ignored.
9774
9775 Example:
9776 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9777 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9778 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9779 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9780
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009781 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009782 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009783
9784
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009785stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009786 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9788 no | no | yes | yes
9789
9790 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009791 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009792 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009793 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009794 server is selected.
9795
9796 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9797 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9798 the "stick-table" statement.
9799
9800 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9801 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9802 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9803 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9804
9805 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9806 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9807 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9808 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9809 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9810 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009811 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009812 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9813 rules.
9814
9815 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9816 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9817 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9818 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9819 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9820 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9821 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9822
9823 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9824 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9825 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9826 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9827
9828 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9829 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9830 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9831 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9832 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9833 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009834 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9835 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9836 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9837 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9838 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9839 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9840 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9841 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9842 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009843
9844 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9845
9846 Example :
9847 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9848 backend https
9849 mode tcp
9850 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009851 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009852 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009853
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009854 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9855 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9856
9857 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9858 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9859 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9860
9861 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9862 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009863
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009864 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9865 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9866 # at offset 44.
9867
9868 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9869 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9870
9871 # Learn on response if server hello.
9872 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009873
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009874 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9875 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9876
9877 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9878 extraction.
9879
9880
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009881tcp-check connect [params*]
9882 Opens a new connection
9883 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9884 no | no | yes | yes
9885
9886 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9887 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9888 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9889
9890 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9891 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9892 of the sequence.
9893
9894 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9895 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9896 do.
9897
9898 Parameters :
9899 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9900 use the TCP connection.
9901
9902 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9903 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9904 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9905
9906 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9907
9908 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9909
9910 Examples:
9911 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9912 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9913 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9914 option tcp-check
9915 tcp-check connect
9916 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9917 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9918 tcp-check send \r\n
9919 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9920 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9921 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9922 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9923 tcp-check send \r\n
9924 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9925 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9926
9927 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9928 option tcp-check
9929 tcp-check connect port 110
9930 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9931 tcp-check connect port 143
9932 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9933 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9934
9935 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9936
9937
9938tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009939 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009940 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9941 no | no | yes | yes
9942
9943 Arguments :
9944 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9945 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9946 binary.
9947 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9948 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9949 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9950
9951 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9952 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9953 with the usual backslash ('\').
9954 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009955 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009956 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9957 used upper or lower case.
9958
9959
9960 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9961
9962 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9963 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9964 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9965 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9966 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9967 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9968 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9969 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9970
9971 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9972 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9973 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9974 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9975 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9976 expression.
9977
9978 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9979 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9980 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9981 this exact hexadecimal string.
9982 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9983
9984 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9985 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9986 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9987 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9988 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9989 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9990 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9991 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9992 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9993 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9994 the null character.
9995
9996 Examples :
9997 # perform a POP check
9998 option tcp-check
9999 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10000
10001 # perform an IMAP check
10002 option tcp-check
10003 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10004
10005 # look for the redis master server
10006 option tcp-check
10007 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010008 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010009 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10010 tcp-check expect string role:master
10011 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10012 tcp-check expect string +OK
10013
10014
10015 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10016 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10017
10018
10019tcp-check send <data>
10020 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10021 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10022 no | no | yes | yes
10023
10024 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10025 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
10026
10027 Examples :
10028 # look for the redis master server
10029 option tcp-check
10030 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10031 tcp-check expect string role:master
10032
10033 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10034 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10035
10036
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010037tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
10038 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010039 tcp health check
10040 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10041 no | no | yes | yes
10042
10043 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10044 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010045 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010046 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
10047 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
10048 hexadecimal string.
10049 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
10050
10051 Examples :
10052 # redis check in binary
10053 option tcp-check
10054 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10055 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10056
10057
10058 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10059 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10060
10061
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010062tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10063 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10065 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010066 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010067 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10068 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010069
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010070 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010071
10072 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10073 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010074 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10075 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10076 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10077 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10078 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10079 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010080
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010081 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10082 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10083 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10084 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010085
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010086 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010087 - accept :
10088 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10089 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10090 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010091
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010092 - reject :
10093 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10094 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10095 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10096 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10097 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10098 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10099 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10100 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10101 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10102 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10103 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010104 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010105
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010106 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10107 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10108 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10109 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10110 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10111 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10112 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10113 hosts.
10114
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010115 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10116 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10117 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10118 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10119 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10120 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10121 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10122 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10123
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010124 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10125 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10126 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10127 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10128 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10129 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10130 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10131 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10132 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010133 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10134 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010135
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010136 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010137 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010138 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10139 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10140 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010141 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010142 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10143 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10144 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10145 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10146 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10147 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10148 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10149 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010150
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010151 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010152 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010153 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010154 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010155 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10156 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10157 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010158
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010159 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10160 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10161 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10162 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010163
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010164 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10165 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10166 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10167 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10168 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010169 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10170 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10171 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10172 layer7 information is extracted.
10173
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010174 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10175 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10176 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10177 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10178 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010179
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010180 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10181 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10182 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10183 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10184
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010185 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10186 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10187 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10188 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10189
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010190 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
10191 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10192 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10193 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10194 continues.
10195
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010196 - set-src <expr> :
10197 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10198 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10199 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010200 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010201
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010202 Arguments:
10203 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10204 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010205
10206 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010207 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10208
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010209 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10210 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010211
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010212 - set-src-port <expr> :
10213 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10214 expression.
10215
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010216 Arguments:
10217 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10218 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010219
10220 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010221 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10222
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010223 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10224 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10225 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010226
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010227 - set-dst <expr> :
10228 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10229 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10230 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10231 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10232 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10233
10234 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10235 followed by some converters.
10236
10237 Example:
10238
10239 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10240 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10241
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010242 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10243 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10244
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010245 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10246 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10247 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10248 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10249
10250
10251 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10252 followed by some converters.
10253
10254 Example:
10255
10256 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10257
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010258 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10259 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10260 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10261
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010262 - "silent-drop" :
10263 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010264 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010265 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10266 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10267 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10268 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10269 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010270 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10271 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010272 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10273 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010274 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010275 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10276 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10277 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10278 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10279
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010280 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10281 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10282 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010283
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010284 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10285 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10286 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010287
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010288 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010289 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010290 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010291
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010292 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10293 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10294 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010295
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010296 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010297 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10298 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010299
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010300 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10301
10302 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10303
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010304 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10305
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010306 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010307
10308
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010309tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10310 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010312 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010313 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010314 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10315 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010316
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010317 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010318
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010319 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010320 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10321 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10322 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10323 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010324
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010325 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10326 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10327 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10328 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010329 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10330 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10331 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10332 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10333 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10334 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010335 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010336 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010337
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010338 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10339 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10340 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10341 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010342
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010343 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010344 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010345 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010346 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10347 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010348 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010349 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010350 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010351 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +020010352 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010353 - set-dst <expr>
10354 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010355 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010356 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010357 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010358 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010359 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010360
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010361 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10362 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010363 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10364 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010365
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010366 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10367 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10368 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10369 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10370 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10371 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010372
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010373 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010374 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10375 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010376
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010377 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010378 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10379 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10380 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10381 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010382 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10383 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10384 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010385
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010386 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010387 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10388 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10389 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010390
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010391 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10392 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10393
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010394 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010395 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10396 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010397
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010398 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10399 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010400 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010401 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10402 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010403 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010404 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010405 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010406 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10407 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010408 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010409 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10410 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010411
10412 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10413 followed by some converters.
10414
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010415 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10416 <var-name>.
10417
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010418 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10419 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10420 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10421 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10422 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10423
10424 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10425 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10426 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10427 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10428 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10429 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10430 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10431 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10432 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10433 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10434 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10435
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010436 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10437 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10438 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10439 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10440 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10441
10442 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10443
10444 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10445
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010446 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10447 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10448 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10449 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10450 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10451 evaluated.
10452
10453 Example:
10454 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10455
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010456 Example:
10457
10458 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010459 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010460
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010461 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010462 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10463 # and reject everything else.
10464 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10465 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010466 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010467 tcp-request content reject
10468
10469 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010470 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10471 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10472 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010473 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010474
10475 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10476 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10477 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010478 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010479 tcp-request content reject
10480
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010481 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010482 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010483 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010484 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010485 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10486 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010487
10488 Example:
10489 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10490 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010491 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010492
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010493 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010494 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010495
10496 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010497 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010498 # protecting all our sites
10499 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010500 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10501 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010502 ...
10503 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10504
10505 backend http_dynamic
10506 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010507 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010508 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010509 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010510 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010511 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010512 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010514 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010515
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010516 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10517 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010518
10519
10520tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10521 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010523 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010524 Arguments :
10525 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10526 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10527 as explained at the top of this document.
10528
10529 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10530 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10531 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10532 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10533 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10534
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010535 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10536 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10537 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10538 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10539
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010540 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10541 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010542 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010543 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010544 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10545 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10546 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10547 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010548
10549 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10550 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10551 it pass through unaffected.
10552
10553 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10554 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10555 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010556 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010557 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10558 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010559 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10560 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10561 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010562
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010563 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010564 "timeout client".
10565
10566
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010567tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10568 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10570 no | no | yes | yes
10571 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010572 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10573 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010574
10575 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10576
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010577 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010578 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10579 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010580 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10581 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010582
10583 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10584
10585 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10586 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10587 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10588 inserted.
10589
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010590 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010591 - accept :
10592 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10593 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10594 the rules evaluation.
10595
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010596 - close :
10597 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10598 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10599 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10600 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10601 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10602 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010603 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010604 protocols.
10605
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010606 - reject :
10607 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10608 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010609 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010610
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010611 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10612 Sets a variable.
10613
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010614 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10615 Unsets a variable.
10616
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010617 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10618 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10619 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10620 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10621
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010622 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10623 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10624 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10625 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10626
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010627 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10628 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10629 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10630 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10631 continues.
10632
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010633 - "silent-drop" :
10634 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010635 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010636 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10637 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10638 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10639 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10640 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010641 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10642 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010643 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10644 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010645 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010646 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10647 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10648 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10649 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10650
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010651 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10652 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10653
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010654 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10655 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10656 for changing the default action to a reject.
10657
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010658 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10659 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10660 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10661 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010662 period.
10663
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010664 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10665 declared inline.
10666
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010667 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10668 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010669 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010670 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10671 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010672 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010673 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010674 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010675 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10676 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010677 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010678 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10679 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010680
10681 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10682 followed by some converters.
10683
10684 Example:
10685
10686 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10687
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010688 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10689 <var-name>.
10690
10691 Example:
10692
10693 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10694
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010695 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10696 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10697 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10698 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10699 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10700
10701 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10702
10703 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10704
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010705 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10706
10707 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10708
10709
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010710tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10711 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10713 no | yes | yes | no
10714 Arguments :
10715 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10716 below.
10717
10718 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10719
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010720 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010721 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10722 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10723 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10724 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10725 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10726 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10727 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010728 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010729 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10730 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10731 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10732 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10733 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10734 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10735 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10736 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10737 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10738 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10739 instead.
10740
10741 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10742 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10743 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10744 rules which may be inserted.
10745
10746 Several types of actions are supported :
10747 - accept : the request is accepted
10748 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10749 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10750 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010751 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010752 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Christopher Faulet5fe76a752021-06-23 12:19:25 +020010753 - set-dst <expr>
10754 - set-dst-port <expr>
10755 - set-src <expr>
10756 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010757 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010758 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010759 - silent-drop
10760
10761 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10762 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10763 sections for a complete description.
10764
10765 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10766 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10767 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10768
10769 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10770 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10771 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10772 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10773 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10774
10775 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10776 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10777
10778 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10779 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10780 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10781
10782 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10783 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10784 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10785
10786 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10787 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10788 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10789
10790 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10791 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10792 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10793
10794 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10795
10796 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10797
10798
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010799tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10800 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10802 no | no | yes | yes
10803 Arguments :
10804 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10805 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10806 as explained at the top of this document.
10807
10808 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10809
10810
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010811timeout check <timeout>
10812 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10813 established.
10814
10815 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10816 yes | no | yes | yes
10817 Arguments:
10818 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10819 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10820 as explained at the top of this document.
10821
10822 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10823 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010824 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010825 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010826 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10827 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10828 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010829
10830 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10831 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10832
10833 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10834 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010835 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010836
10837 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10838 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10839 forget about it.
10840
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010841 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10842 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010843
10844
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010845timeout client <timeout>
10846timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10847 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10849 yes | yes | yes | no
10850 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010851 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010852 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10853 as explained at the top of this document.
10854
10855 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10856 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10857 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010858 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10859 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10860 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10861 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010862 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10863 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10864 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010865 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010866 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010867 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10868 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010869 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10870 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010871
10872 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10873 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10874 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10875 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010876 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010877 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10878
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010879 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010880
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010881 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10882 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10883 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10884
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010885 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10886 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010887
10888
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010889timeout client-fin <timeout>
10890 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10892 yes | yes | yes | no
10893 Arguments :
10894 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10895 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10896 as explained at the top of this document.
10897
10898 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10899 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10900 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10901 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10902 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10903 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10904 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010905 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10906 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10907 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010908
10909 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10910 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10911 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10912
10913 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10914
10915
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010916timeout connect <timeout>
10917timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10918 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10920 yes | no | yes | yes
10921 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010922 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010923 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10924 as explained at the top of this document.
10925
10926 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010927 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010928 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010929 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010930 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10931 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010932
10933 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10934 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10935 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10936 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010937 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010938 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10939
10940 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10941 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10942 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10943
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010944 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10945 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010946
10947
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010948timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10949 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10951 yes | yes | yes | yes
10952 Arguments :
10953 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10954 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10955 as explained at the top of this document.
10956
10957 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10958 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10959 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10960 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10961 once the request has started to present itself.
10962
10963 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10964 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10965 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10966 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10967 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10968
10969 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10970 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10971 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10972 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10973
10974 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10975 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010976 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010977 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10978 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010979 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010980
10981 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10982 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10983 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10984 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10985
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010986 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10987 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010988 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10989
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010990 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10991
10992
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010993timeout http-request <timeout>
10994 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010996 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010997 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010998 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010999 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11000 as explained at the top of this document.
11001
11002 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11003 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11004 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11005 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11006 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11007 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11008 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011009 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11010 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11011 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11012 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011013 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011014 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11015 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011016
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011017 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11018 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11019 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11020 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11021 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011022 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011023
11024 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11025 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011026 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011027 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11028 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11029
11030 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011031 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11032 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11033 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011034
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011035 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011036 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011037
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011038
11039timeout queue <timeout>
11040 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11042 yes | no | yes | yes
11043 Arguments :
11044 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11045 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11046 as explained at the top of this document.
11047
11048 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11049 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11050 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11051 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11052 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11053
11054 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11055 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11056 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11057 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11058
11059 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
11060
11061
11062timeout server <timeout>
11063timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
11064 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11066 yes | no | yes | yes
11067 Arguments :
11068 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11069 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11070 as explained at the top of this document.
11071
11072 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11073 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11074 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11075 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11076 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11077 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11078 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11079
11080 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11081 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11082 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11083 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11084 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011085 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011086 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011087 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11088 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011089 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11090 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011091
11092 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11093 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11094 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11095 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011096 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011097 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11098
11099 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
11100 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
11101 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
11102
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011103 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011104
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011105
11106timeout server-fin <timeout>
11107 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11109 yes | no | yes | yes
11110 Arguments :
11111 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11112 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11113 as explained at the top of this document.
11114
11115 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11116 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11117 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11118 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11119 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11120 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11121 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11122 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11123 situations, it should not be needed.
11124
11125 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11126 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11127 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11128
11129 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11130
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011131
11132timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011133 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11135 yes | yes | yes | yes
11136 Arguments :
11137 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11138 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11139 as explained at the top of this document.
11140
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011141 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
11142 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
11143 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
11144 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011145
11146 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11147 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11148 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11149 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011150 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011151
11152 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
11153
11154
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011155timeout tunnel <timeout>
11156 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11158 yes | no | yes | yes
11159 Arguments :
11160 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11161 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11162 as explained at the top of this document.
11163
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011164 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011165 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11166 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11167 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011168 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11169 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011170 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11171 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11172 specified.
11173
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011174 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11175 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11176 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11177 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11178 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11179 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11180 state.
11181
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011182 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11183 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11184 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11185 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011186 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011187
11188 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11189 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11190 forget about it.
11191
11192 Example :
11193 defaults http
11194 option http-server-close
11195 timeout connect 5s
11196 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011197 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011198 timeout server 30s
11199 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11200
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011201 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011202
11203
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011204transparent (deprecated)
11205 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011207 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011208 Arguments : none
11209
11210 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11211 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11212 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11213 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11214 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11215 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11216 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11217 appropriate server.
11218
11219 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11220
11221 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11222 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11223
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011224 See also: "option transparent"
11225
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011226unique-id-format <string>
11227 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11229 yes | yes | yes | no
11230 Arguments :
11231 <string> is a log-format string.
11232
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011233 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11234 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11235 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11236 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011237
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011238 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11239 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11240 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11241 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11242 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11243 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11244 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11245 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011246
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011247 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11248 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011249
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011250 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011251
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011252 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011253
11254 will generate:
11255
11256 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11257
11258 See also: "unique-id-header"
11259
11260unique-id-header <name>
11261 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11263 yes | yes | yes | no
11264 Arguments :
11265 <name> is the name of the header.
11266
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011267 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11268 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011269
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011270 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011271
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011272 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011273 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11274
11275 will generate:
11276
11277 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11278
11279 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011280
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011281use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011282 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11284 no | yes | yes | no
11285 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011286 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11287 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011288
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011289 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11290 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011291
11292 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11293 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11294 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011295 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011296 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011297 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11298 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011299
11300 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11301 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11302 assign the backend.
11303
11304 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11305 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11306 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11307 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11308 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11309 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11310
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011311 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011312 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011313 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11314 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11315 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11316
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011317 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11318 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11319 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11320 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11321 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11322 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11323 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11324 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11325 cannot be forced from the request.
11326
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011327 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011328 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11329 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11330
11331 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11332 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011333
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011334
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011335use-server <server> if <condition>
11336use-server <server> unless <condition>
11337 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11339 no | no | yes | yes
11340 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011341 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011342
11343 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11344
11345 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11346 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11347 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11348
11349 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11350 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11351 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11352 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11353 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11354 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11355 matches will assign the server.
11356
11357 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11358 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11359 with the next rules until one matches.
11360
11361 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11362 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11363 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11364 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11365
11366 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11367 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11368 stripped.
11369
11370 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11371 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11372 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11373 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11374
11375 Example :
11376 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11377 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11378 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11379 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11380 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11381 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011382 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011383 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11384 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11385
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011386 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011387
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011388
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100113895. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011390--------------------------
11391
11392The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11393depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11394settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11395written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11396described in this section.
11397
11398
113995.1. Bind options
11400-----------------
11401
11402The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11403as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11404no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11405parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11406while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11407provided immediately after the setting name.
11408
11409The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11410
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011411accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11412 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11413 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11414 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11415 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11416 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11417 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11418 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11419 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11420 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011421 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11422 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11423 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011424
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011425accept-proxy
11426 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011427 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11428 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011429 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11430 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11431 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11432 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011433 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011434 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11435 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011436 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11437 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011438
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011439allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011440 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011441 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011442 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011443 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11444 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011445
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011446alpn <protocols>
11447 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11448 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11449 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011450 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011451 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011452 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11453 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11454 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11455 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11456 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11457 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11458 preference, like below :
11459
11460 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011461
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011462backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011463 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011464 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11465
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011466curves <curves>
11467 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11468 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11469 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11470 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11471 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11472 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11473
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011474ecdhe <named curve>
11475 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011476 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11477 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011478
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011479ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011480 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11481 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11482 client's certificate.
11483
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011484ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11485 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11486 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11487 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11488 error is ignored.
11489
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011490ca-sign-file <cafile>
11491 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11492 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11493 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11494 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11495 'generate-certificates' for details.
11496
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011497ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011498 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11499 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11500 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11501 'generate-certificates' for details.
11502
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011503ciphers <ciphers>
11504 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11505 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011506 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011507 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011508 information and recommendations see e.g.
11509 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11510 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11511 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11512
11513ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11514 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11515 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11516 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11517 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011518 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11519 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011520
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011521crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011522 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11523 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11524 to verify client's certificate.
11525
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011526crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011527 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11528 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11529 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11530 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11531 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11532 file.
11533
11534 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11535 are loaded.
11536
11537 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011538 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011539 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11540 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11541 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11542 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011543 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11544 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011545 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011546
11547 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11548 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11549 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11550 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011551 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11552 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011553
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011554 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011555
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011556 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011557 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011558 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11559 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011560 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11561 clients).
11562
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011563 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11564 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11565 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11566 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11567 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11568 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11569 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11570 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11571 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11572 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11573 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11574 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11575 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11576
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011577 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11578 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11579 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11580 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11581 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11582
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011583 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11584 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11585 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11586 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011587
11588 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11589 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11590 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11591 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11592 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11593 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11594 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11595 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11596 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11597
11598 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11599
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011600 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011601 a cert bundle.
11602
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011603 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011604 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11605 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11606 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11607 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11608 provide multi-cert support.
11609
11610 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11611
11612 Filename | CN | SAN
11613 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11614 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011615 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011616 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11617 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11618
11619 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11620 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11621 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11622 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011623 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11624 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11625 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011626
11627 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11628 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11629
11630 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11631 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11632 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11633
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011634crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011635 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011636 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011637 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011638 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011639
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011640crt-list <file>
11641 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011642 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11643 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011644
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011645 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11646
William Lallemand0b77c182020-06-30 16:11:36 +020011647 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ciphers",
11648 "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names", "npn",
11649 "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
11650 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
11651 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011652
William Lallemandb0b703f2020-10-06 17:06:11 +020011653 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filters can be specified
11654 in the configuration, but they are only used as a hint, they don't do
11655 anything. (this changes in newer haproxy versions) If you want to exclude a
11656 SNI from a wildcard, use this positive SNI on another line. (like in the
11657 example).
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011658 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11659 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11660 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11661 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11662 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11663 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011664
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011665 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011666 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011667 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11668 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11669 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011670
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011671 crt-list file example:
11672 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011673 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011674 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011675 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011676
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011677defer-accept
11678 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11679 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11680 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011681 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011682 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11683 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11684 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11685 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11686 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11687 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11688 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11689
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011690expose-fd listeners
11691 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11692 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011693 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11694 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011695 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011696
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011697force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011698 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011699 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011700 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011701 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011702
11703force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011704 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011705 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011706 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011707
11708force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011709 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011710 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011711 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011712
11713force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011714 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011715 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011716 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011717
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011718force-tlsv13
11719 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11720 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011721 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011722
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011723generate-certificates
11724 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11725 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11726 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11727 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11728 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11729 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11730 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11731 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11732 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11733 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11734 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11735
11736 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11737 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011738 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011739 certificate is used many times.
11740
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011741gid <gid>
11742 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11743 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11744 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11745 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11746 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11747
11748group <group>
11749 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11750 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11751 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11752 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11753 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11754
11755id <id>
11756 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11757 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11758 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11759 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11760
11761interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011762 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11763 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11764 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11765 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11766 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11767 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011768 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11769 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11770 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11771 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11772 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11773 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011774
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011775level <level>
11776 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11777 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11778 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011779 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011780 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11781 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11782 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011783 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011784 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011785 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011786 all counters).
11787
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011788severity-output <format>
11789 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11790 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11791 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11792 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11793 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11794 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11795 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11796 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11797 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11798 rfc5424 convention.
11799
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011800maxconn <maxconn>
11801 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11802 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11803 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11804 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11805 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11806 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11807 eat all memory.
11808
11809mode <mode>
11810 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11811 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11812 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11813 UNIX sockets.
11814
11815mss <maxseg>
11816 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11817 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11818 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11819 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11820 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11821 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11822 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11823 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11824 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11825 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11826 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11827
11828name <name>
11829 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11830 page.
11831
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011832namespace <name>
11833 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11834 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11835 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11836 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11837
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011838nice <nice>
11839 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11840 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11841 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11842 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11843 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11844 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11845 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11846 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11847 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11848 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11849 one for an RDP socket.
11850
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011851no-ca-names
11852 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11853 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11854
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011855no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011857 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011858 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011859 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011860 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11861 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011862
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011863no-tls-tickets
11864 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11865 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11866 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011867 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11868 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010011869 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
11870 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
11871 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011872
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011873no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011874 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011875 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011876 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011877 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011878 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11879 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011880
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011881no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011882 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011883 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011884 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011885 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011886 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11887 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011888
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011889no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011890 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011891 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011892 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011893 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011894 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11895 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011896
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011897no-tlsv13
11898 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11899 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11900 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11901 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011902 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11903 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011904
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011905npn <protocols>
11906 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11907 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11908 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011909 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011910 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011911 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11912 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11913 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11914 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11915 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011916
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011917prefer-client-ciphers
11918 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11919 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11920 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011921 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11922 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11923 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011924
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011925process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011926 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011927 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011928 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011929 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11930 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11931 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11932 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011933 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011934 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11935 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11936 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11937 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11938 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011939
11940 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11941
11942 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11943 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11944 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11945 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11946 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11947 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11948 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11949 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011950
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011951proto <name>
11952 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11953 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11954 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11955 in haproxy -vv.
11956 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11957 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011958 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011959 h2" on the bind line.
11960
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011961ssl
11962 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011963 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011964 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11965 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011966 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11967 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011968
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011969ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11970 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11971 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11972 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11973
11974ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11975 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11976 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11977 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11978
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011979strict-sni
11980 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11981 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11982 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11983 See the "crt" option for more information.
11984
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011985tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011986 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011987 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11988 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011989 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011990 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11991 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11992 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11993 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11994 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11995 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11996 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11997
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011998tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011999 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012000 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12001 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12002 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12003 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12004 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12005 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12006 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012007 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12008 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12009 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012010
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012011tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12012 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012013 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12014 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12015 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12016 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12017 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12018 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12019 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12020 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12021 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12022 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012023 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12024 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12025
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012026transparent
12027 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12028 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12029 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12030 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12031 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12032 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12033 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12034 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12035 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12036 so check for support with your vendor.
12037
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012038v4v6
12039 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12040 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12041 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12042 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012043 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012044
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012045v6only
12046 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12047 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12048 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012049 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12050 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012051
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012052uid <uid>
12053 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12054 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12055 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12056 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12057 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12058
12059user <user>
12060 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12061 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12062 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12063 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12064 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12065
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012066verify [none|optional|required]
12067 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12068 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12069 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12070 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12071 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012072 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12073 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12074 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12075 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012076
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200120775.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012078------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012079
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012080The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12081which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12082arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12083settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12084after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12085Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12086address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012087
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012088 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012089 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012090
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012091Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12092keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12093
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012094The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012095
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012096addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012097 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012098 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12099 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12100 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12101 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12102 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012103
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012104agent-check
12105 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012106 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012107 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12108 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12109 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012110
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012111 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012112 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012113 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12114 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12115 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012116
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012117 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12118 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12119 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12120 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12121 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012122
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012123 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012124 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012125
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012126 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12127 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12128 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012129
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012130 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12131 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12132 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012133
William Dauchyd58def32020-09-26 13:35:51 +020012134 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012135 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12136 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12137 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12138 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012139 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012140 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012141
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012142 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12143 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012144
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012145 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12146 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12147 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12148 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12149 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12150 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12151 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12152 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12153 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012154
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012155 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12156 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012157 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12158 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12159 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012160 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012161
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012162 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012163 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012164
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012165agent-send <string>
12166 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12167 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12168 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12169 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12170 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12171
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012172agent-inter <delay>
12173 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12174 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12175
12176 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12177 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12178 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12179 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12180 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12181 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12182 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12183 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12184 of backends use the same servers.
12185
12186 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12187
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012188agent-addr <addr>
12189 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12190
12191 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12192 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12193 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12194 hostname, it will be resolved.
12195
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012196agent-port <port>
12197 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12198
12199 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12200
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012201allow-0rtt
12202 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012203 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12204 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012205
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012206alpn <protocols>
12207 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12208 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12209 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012210 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012211 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12212 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12213 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12214 now obsolete NPN extension.
12215 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12216 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12217
12218 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12219
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012220backup
12221 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12222 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12223 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12224 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012225 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12226 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012227
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012228ca-file <cafile>
12229 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12230 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12231 server's certificate.
12232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012233check
12234 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012235 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12236 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12237 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12238 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12239 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12240 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12241 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012242 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12243 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012244 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12245 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012246
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012247check-send-proxy
12248 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12249 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12250 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12251 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12252 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12253 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12254 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12255
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012256check-alpn <protocols>
12257 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12258 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12259 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12260
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012261check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012262 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012263 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12264 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012265
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012266check-ssl
12267 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12268 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12269 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12270 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012271 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012272 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12273 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012274 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012275 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12276 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012277
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012278check-via-socks4
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012279 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012280 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12281 for normal traffic.
12282
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012283ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12285 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12286 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012287 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12288 information and recommendations see e.g.
12289 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12290 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12291 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012292
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012293ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12294 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12295 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12296 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12297 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012298 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12299 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12300 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012302cookie <value>
12303 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12304 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12305 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12306 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12307 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12308 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12309 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12310
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012311crl-file <crlfile>
12312 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12313 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12314 to verify server's certificate.
12315
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012316crt <cert>
12317 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12318 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12319 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12320 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12321 certificate request.
12322
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012323disabled
12324 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12325 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12326 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12327 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12328 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012329 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012330
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012331enabled
12332 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12333 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12334 default value.
12335 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12336 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012337
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012338error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012339 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12340 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12341 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012343 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012344
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012345fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012346 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12347 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12348 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12349
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012350force-sslv3
12351 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12352 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012353 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012354 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012355
12356force-tlsv10
12357 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012358 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012359 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012360
12361force-tlsv11
12362 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012363 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012364 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012365
12366force-tlsv12
12367 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012368 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012369 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012370
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012371force-tlsv13
12372 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12373 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012374 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012376id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012377 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12378 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12379 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012380
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012381init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12382 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12383 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012384 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012385 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12386 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12387 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12388 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12389 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12390 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12391 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12392 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12393 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012394 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012395 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12396 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12397 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12398 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12399 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12400 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012401 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012402
12403 Example:
12404 defaults
12405 # never fail on address resolution
12406 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012408inter <delay>
12409fastinter <delay>
12410downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012411 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12412 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12413 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12414 between checks depending on the server state :
12415
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012416 Server state | Interval used
12417 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12418 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12419 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12420 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12421 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12422 or yet unchecked. |
12423 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12424 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12425 | "inter" otherwise.
12426 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012427
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012428 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12429 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12430 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12431 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012432 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12433 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12434 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12435 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12436 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012438maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012439 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12440 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012441 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12442 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012443 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12444 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12445 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12446 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12447
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012448 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12449 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12450 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12451 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12452 than 50 concurrent requests.
12453
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012454maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012455 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12456 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12457 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12458 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12459 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12460 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12461 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12462
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012463max-reuse <count>
12464 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12465 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12466 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12467 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12468 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12469 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12470 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12471 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12472
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012473minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012474 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12475 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12476 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12477 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12478 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12479 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012480 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012481 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012482
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012483namespace <name>
12484 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12485 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12486 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12487 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12488
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012489no-agent-check
12490 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12491 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12492 default value.
12493 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12494 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12495
12496no-backup
12497 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12498 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12499 default value.
12500 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12501 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12502
12503no-check
12504 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12505 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12506 default value.
12507 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12508 "default-server" "check" setting.
12509
12510no-check-ssl
12511 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12512 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12513 default value.
12514 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12515 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12516
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012517no-send-proxy
12518 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12519 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12520 default value.
12521 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12522 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12523
12524no-send-proxy-v2
12525 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12526 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12527 default value.
12528 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12529 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12530
12531no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12532 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12533 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12534 default value.
12535 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12536 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12537
12538no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12539 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12540 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12541 default value.
12542 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12543 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12544
12545no-ssl
12546 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12547 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12548 default value.
12549 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12550 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12551
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012552no-ssl-reuse
12553 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12554 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12555 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12556 and for paranoid users.
12557
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012558no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012559 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12560 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012561 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012562
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012563 Supported in default-server: No
12564
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012565no-tls-tickets
12566 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12567 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12568 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012569 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12570 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012571 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12572 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12573 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012574 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012575
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012576no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012577 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012578 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12579 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012580 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12581 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012582 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012583
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012584 Supported in default-server: No
12585
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012586no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012587 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012588 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12589 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012590 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12591 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012592 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012593
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012594 Supported in default-server: No
12595
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012596no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012597 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012598 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12599 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012600 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12601 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012602 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012603
12604 Supported in default-server: No
12605
12606no-tlsv13
12607 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12608 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12609 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12610 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12611 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012612 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012613
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012614 Supported in default-server: No
12615
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012616no-verifyhost
12617 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12618 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12619 default value.
12620 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12621 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012622
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012623no-tfo
12624 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12625 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12626 default value.
12627 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12628 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12629
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012630non-stick
12631 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12632 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12633 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12634
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012635npn <protocols>
12636 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12637 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12638 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012639 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012640 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12641 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12642 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12643
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012644observe <mode>
12645 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12646 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12647 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12648 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12649 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12650 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012651 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012652
12653 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12654
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012655on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012656 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12657 Currently, four modes are available:
12658 - fastinter: force fastinter
12659 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12660 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12661 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12662 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12663
12664 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12665
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012666on-marked-down <action>
12667 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12668 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012669 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12670 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12671 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12672 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12673 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12674 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12675 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12676 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012677
12678 Actions are disabled by default
12679
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012680on-marked-up <action>
12681 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12682 Currently one action is available:
12683 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12684 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12685 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12686 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012687 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12688 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012689 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12690 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12691
12692 Actions are disabled by default
12693
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012694pool-max-conn <max>
12695 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12696 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12697 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12698 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12699 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12700 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12701
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012702pool-purge-delay <delay>
12703 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012704 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012705 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012706
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012707port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012708 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12709 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12710 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12711 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12712 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12713 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12714
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012715proto <name>
12716
12717 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12718 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12719 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12720 reported in haproxy -vv.
12721 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12722 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012724redir <prefix>
12725 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12726 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12727 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12728 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12729 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12730 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12731 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12732 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012733 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012734 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012735 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12736 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12737 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12738 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12739
12740 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12741
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012742rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012743 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12744 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12745 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12746
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012747resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12748 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12749 server.
12750
12751 Available options:
12752
12753 * allow-dup-ip
12754 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12755 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12756 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12757 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12758 For such case, simply enable this option.
12759 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12760
12761 * prevent-dup-ip
12762 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12763 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12764 same fqdn.
12765 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12766
12767 Example:
12768 backend b_myapp
12769 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12770 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12771 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12772
12773 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12774 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12775 it
12776 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12777 different address
12778
12779 Default value: not set
12780
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012781resolve-prefer <family>
12782 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12783 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12784 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12785 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12786
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012787 Default value: ipv6
12788
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012789 Example:
12790
12791 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012792
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012793resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012794 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012795 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012796 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012797 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12798 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012799 configured network, another address is selected.
12800
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012801 Example:
12802
12803 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012804
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012805resolvers <id>
12806 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12807 hostname.
12808
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012809 Example:
12810
12811 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012812
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012813 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012814
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012815send-proxy
12816 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12817 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12818 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12819 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012820 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12821 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12822 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12823 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12824 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12825 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12826 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12827 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12828 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12829 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012830 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12831 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012832
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012833send-proxy-v2
12834 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12835 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12836 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12837 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012838 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12839 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12840 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12841 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012842
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012843proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12844 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12845 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012846 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12847 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012848 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12849 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012850 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012851
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012852send-proxy-v2-ssl
12853 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12854 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12855 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12856 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12857 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12858 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12859 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012860 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12861 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012862
12863send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12864 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12865 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12866 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12867 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12868 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12869 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12870 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12871 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012872 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12873 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012874
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012875slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012876 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12877 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12878 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12879 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12880 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12881 parameters :
12882
12883 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12884 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12885
12886 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12887 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12888 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12889 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12890
12891 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12892 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12893 seen as failed.
12894
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012895sni <expression>
12896 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12897 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12898 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12899 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012900 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12901 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012902 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012903 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12904 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012905
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012906source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012907source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012908source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012909 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12910 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12911 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12912 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12913
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012914 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12915 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12916 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12917 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12918 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12919 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12920 server.
12921
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012922 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12923 specifying the source address without port(s).
12924
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012925ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012926 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12927 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12928 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12929 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12930 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12931 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012932 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12933 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012934
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012935ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12936 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12937 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12938 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12939
12940ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12941 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12942 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12943 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12944
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012945ssl-reuse
12946 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12947 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12948 default value.
12949 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12950 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12951
12952stick
12953 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12954 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12955 default value.
12956 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12957 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012958
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012959socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012960 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012961 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12962 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12963
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012964tcp-ut <delay>
12965 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12966 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12967 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012968 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012969 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12970 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12971 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12972 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12973 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12974 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12975 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12976 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12977 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12978
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012979tfo
12980 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12981 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12982 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12983 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12984 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012985 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012987track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012988 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12989 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12990 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12991 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012992 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12993
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012994tls-tickets
12995 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12996 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12997 default value.
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012998 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12999 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13000 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013001 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke04037d32020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013002 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013003
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013004verify [none|required]
13005 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013006 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013007 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13008 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013009 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013010 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13011 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13012 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13013 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13014 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13015 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13016 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13017 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013018
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013019verifyhost <hostname>
13020 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013021 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13022 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13023 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13024 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13025 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13026 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13027 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13028 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013030weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013031 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13032 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13033 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013034 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13035 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13036 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13037 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13038 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13039 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013040
13041
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130425.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13043-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013044
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013045HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13046using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombs31d31f92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070013047configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013048This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13049can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13050workload.
13051This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13052resolution at run time.
13053Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13054carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13055
13056
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130575.3.1. Global overview
13058----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013059
13060As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13061different steps of the process life:
13062
13063 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13064 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13065 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13066
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013067 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13068 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013069
13070A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13071 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13072 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13073 resolution to know this new IP.
13074
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013075When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013076HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013077SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13078from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13079will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13080will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013081
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013082A few things important to notice:
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013083 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013084 first valid response.
13085
13086 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13087 servers return an error.
13088
13089
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130905.3.2. The resolvers section
13091----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013092
13093This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013094HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13095contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013096
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013097When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13098uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13099is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13100answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13101
13102When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013103used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013104
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013105 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13106 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13107 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013108
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013109 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13110 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013111
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013112 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13113 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13114 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013115
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013116For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13117following scenarios are possible:
13118
13119 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13120 ignored
13121
13122 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13123 applied
13124
13125 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13126 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13127
13128 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13129 retries the query with a new type
13130
13131 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13132 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013133
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013134As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13135a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013136<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013137
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013138
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013139resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013140 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013141
13142A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13143
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013144accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013145 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013146 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013147 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13148 by RFC 6891)
13149
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013150 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13151
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013152nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13153 DNS server description:
13154 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13155 <ip> : IP address of the server
13156 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13157
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013158parse-resolv-conf
13159 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13160 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13161 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13162
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013163hold <status> <period>
13164 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13165 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013166 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013167 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013168 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13169 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13170 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13171
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013172 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013173
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013174resolve_retries <nb>
13175 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13176 giving up.
13177 Default value: 3
13178
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013179 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13180 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13181 type.
13182
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013183timeout <event> <time>
13184 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13185 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13186 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013187 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13188 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013189 Default value: 1s
13190 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013191 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013192 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013193 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13194 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13195
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013196 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013197
13198 resolvers mydns
13199 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13200 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013201 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013202 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013203 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013204 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013205 hold other 30s
13206 hold refused 30s
13207 hold nx 30s
13208 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013209 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013210 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013211
13212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132136. HTTP header manipulation
13214---------------------------
13215
13216In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
13217response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
13218request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
13219which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013220against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013221
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013222If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
13223to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
13224but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
13225HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
13226stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
13227because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
13228a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
13229still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020013230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013231This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
13232in section 4.2 :
13233
13234 - reqadd <string>
13235 - reqallow <search>
13236 - reqiallow <search>
13237 - reqdel <search>
13238 - reqidel <search>
13239 - reqdeny <search>
13240 - reqideny <search>
13241 - reqpass <search>
13242 - reqipass <search>
13243 - reqrep <search> <replace>
13244 - reqirep <search> <replace>
13245 - reqtarpit <search>
13246 - reqitarpit <search>
13247 - rspadd <string>
13248 - rspdel <search>
13249 - rspidel <search>
13250 - rspdeny <search>
13251 - rspideny <search>
13252 - rsprep <search> <replace>
13253 - rspirep <search> <replace>
13254
13255With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
13256is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
13257parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
13258prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
13259Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
13260
13261 \t for a tab
13262 \r for a carriage return (CR)
13263 \n for a new line (LF)
13264 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
13265 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
13266 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
13267 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
13268 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
13269
13270The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
13271portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
13272above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
13273regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
132749 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
13275is very common to users of the "sed" program.
13276
13277The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
13278after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
13279
13280Notes related to these keywords :
13281---------------------------------
13282 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
13283 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
13284 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
13285
13286 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
13287 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
13288 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
13289
13290 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
13291 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
13292 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
13293 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
13294 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
13295
13296 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
13297 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
13298 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
13299 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
13300 useless headers before adding new ones.
13301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013302 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013303 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
13304
13305 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
13306 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
13307 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
13308
13309 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
13310 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013311 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013312
13313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133147. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13315----------------------------------
13316
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013317HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013318client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13319The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13320these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13321but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13322data called patterns.
13323
13324
133257.1. ACL basics
13326---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013327
13328The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13329content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13330from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13331simple :
13332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013333 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013334 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013335 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13336 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013338The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13339adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013340
13341In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013343 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013344
13345This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13346Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13347and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013348an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13349conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13350as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13351are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013352
13353ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13354'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13355which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13356
13357There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13358performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013360The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13361specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13362this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013363methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13364ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013365
13366Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13367 - boolean
13368 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13369 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13370 - string
13371 - data block
13372
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013373Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13374converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13375would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13376The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13377which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13378
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013379Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13380keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13381fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13382which are summarized in the table below :
13383
13384 +---------------------+-----------------+
13385 | Sample or converter | Default |
13386 | output type | matching method |
13387 +---------------------+-----------------+
13388 | boolean | bool |
13389 +---------------------+-----------------+
13390 | integer | int |
13391 +---------------------+-----------------+
13392 | ip | ip |
13393 +---------------------+-----------------+
13394 | string | str |
13395 +---------------------+-----------------+
13396 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13397 +---------------------+-----------------+
13398
13399Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13400matching method, see below.
13401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013402The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13403 - boolean
13404 - integer or integer range
13405 - IP address / network
13406 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13407 - regular expression
13408 - hex block
13409
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013410The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13411
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013412 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13413 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013414 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013415 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013416 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013417 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013418 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013420The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13421read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13422if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13423lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13424will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13425beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13426a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13427lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13428exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13429
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013430The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13431parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13432ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13433a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13434check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13435
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013436The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13437socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13438file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013440Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13441loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13442
13443 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13444
13445In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13446the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13447case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13448as well.
13449
13450The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13451sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13452do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13453methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13454is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013455obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013456followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13457default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13458that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13459string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13460
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013461The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13462By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13463string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13464resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13465server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013466waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013467flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13468function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013470There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13471sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13472be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013473
13474 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13475 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013476 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13477 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13478 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13479 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013480
13481 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13482 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013483 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013484
13485 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013486 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013487
13488 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013489 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013490
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013491 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013492 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13493
13494 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13495 binary or string samples.
13496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013497 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13498 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013500 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13501 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13502 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013504 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13505 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013507 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13508 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013510 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13511 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013513 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13514 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013515 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013517 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13518 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13519 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013520
13521For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13522request, it is possible to do :
13523
13524 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13525
13526In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13527buffer, one would use the following acl :
13528
13529 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13530
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013531On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13532possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13533
13534 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013536All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13537criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13538method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13539to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13540criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13541the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013543If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013544the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13545For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013547 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13548 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13549 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13550 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013551
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013552
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013553The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13554types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13555combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13556brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13557default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013559 +-------------------------------------------------+
13560 | Input sample type |
13561 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013562 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013563 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13564 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13565 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013566 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013567 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013568 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013569 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013570 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013571 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013572 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013573 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013574 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013575 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013576 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013577 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013578 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013579 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013580 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013581 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013582 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013583 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013584 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013585 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013586 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013587 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13588 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13589 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013590
13591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135927.1.1. Matching booleans
13593------------------------
13594
13595In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13596Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13597When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13598that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13599
13600Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13601return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13602"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13603
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136057.1.2. Matching integers
13606------------------------
13607
13608Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13609enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13610to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13611
13612Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13613matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13614lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013615
13616For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13617unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13618representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13619
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013620As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13621two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13622instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13623ranges and operators.
13624
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013625For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013626operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13627Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13628of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013629
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013630Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013631
13632 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13633 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13634 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13635 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13636 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13637
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013638For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013639
13640 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13641
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013642This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13643
13644 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13645
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136477.1.3. Matching strings
13648-----------------------
13649
13650String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13651different forms :
13652
13653 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013654 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013655
13656 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013657 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013658
13659 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13660 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13661
13662 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13663 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13664
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013665 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013666 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13667 matches.
13668
13669 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13670 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13671 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013672
13673String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13674exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13675characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13676string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13677to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013678before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013679
Mathias Weiersmuellerb2fe2232019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013680Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13681(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13682Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13683
13684Example:
13685 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13686 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13687
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136897.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13690---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013691
13692Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13693they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13694possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13695passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13696the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013697the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13698match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013699
13700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200137017.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13702-------------------------------------
13703
13704It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13705not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13706a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13707to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13708digits may be used upper or lower case.
13709
13710Example :
13711 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13712 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13713
13714
137157.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13716---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013717
13718IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13719netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13720within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013721host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013722difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13723at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13724does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13725parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013726
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013727The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13728abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13729
13730 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13731 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13732 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13733 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13734 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13735 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13736 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13737 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13738
13739Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13740192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13741
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013742IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13743Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13744trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13745IPv6 patterns.
13746
13747HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13748following situations :
13749 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13750 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13751 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13752 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13753 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13754 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13755 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13756 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13757 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13758 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013760
137617.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13762----------------------------------
13763
13764Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13765combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13766
13767 - AND (implicit)
13768 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13769 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013771A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013773 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013775Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13776indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013778For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13779"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13780requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13781is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13782
13783 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013784 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13785 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13786 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013787
13788To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13789and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13790
13791 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13792 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13793 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13794 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13795
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013796 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013797 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13798 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13799 use_backend www if host_www
13800
13801It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13802expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13803be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13804the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13805
13806 The following rule :
13807
13808 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013809 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013810
13811 Can also be written that way :
13812
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013813 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013814
13815It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13816to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13817simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13818sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13819good use is the following :
13820
13821 With named ACLs :
13822
13823 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13824 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13825 monitor fail if site_dead
13826
13827 With anonymous ACLs :
13828
13829 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13830
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013831See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13832keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013833
13834
138357.3. Fetching samples
13836---------------------
13837
13838Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13839against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13840sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13841ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13842of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13843available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13844
13845This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13846Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13847compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13848deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13849
13850The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13851matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13852method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13853indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13854
13855As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13856when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13857mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13858the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13859ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13860
13861Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13862multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13863when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013864incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13865are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013866is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13867all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13868
13869Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13870 - name
13871 - name(arg1)
13872 - name(arg1,arg2)
13873
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013874
138757.3.1. Converters
13876-----------------
13877
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013878Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13879of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13880is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13881was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013882has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013883unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13884
13885These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13886sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13887the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013888support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013889
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013890A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13891support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13892supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13893(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13894bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013896The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013897
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001389851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13899 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13900 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13901 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13902 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13903 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13904
13905 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013906 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13907 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013908 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13909 frontend http-in
13910 bind *:8081
13911 default_backend servers
13912 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13913 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13914
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013915add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013916 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013917 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013918 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13919 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013920 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013921 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13922 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13923 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13924 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013925 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013926 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013927
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013928aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13929 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13930 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13931 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13932 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13933 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13934 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13935
13936 Example:
13937 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13938 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13939
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013940and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013941 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013942 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013943 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13944 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013945 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013946 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13947 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13948 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13949 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013950 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013951 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013952
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013953b64dec
13954 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13955 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13956
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013957base64
13958 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013959 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013960 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13961
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013962bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013963 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013964 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013965 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013966 presence of a flag).
13967
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013968bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13969 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13970 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013971 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013972
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013973concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13974 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13975 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13976 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13977 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13978 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13979 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13980 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13981 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13982 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13983 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013984 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013985 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013986 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013987
13988 Example:
13989 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13990 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13991 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13992 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13993
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013994cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013995 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13996 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013997
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013998crc32([<avalanche>])
13999 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14000 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14001 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14002 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14003 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14004 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14005 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14006 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14007 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14008 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014009 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14010
14011crc32c([<avalanche>])
14012 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14013 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14014 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14015 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14016 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14017 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14018 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14019 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014020
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014021da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014022 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14023 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14024 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14025 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014026 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014027 configuration language.
14028
14029 Example:
14030 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014031 bind *:8881
14032 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014033 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014034
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014035debug
14036 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
14037 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
14038 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
14039
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014040div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014041 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14042 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014043 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014044 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14045 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014046 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014047 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14048 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14049 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14050 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014051 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014052 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014053
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014054djb2([<avalanche>])
14055 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14056 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14057 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14058 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14059 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14060 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14061 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014062 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14063 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014064
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014065even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014066 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014067 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14068
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014069field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14070 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14071 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14072 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14073 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14074 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14075 fields.
14076
14077 Example :
14078 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14079 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14080 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14081 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14082 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014083
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014084hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014085 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014086 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014087 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014088 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014089
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014090hex2i
14091 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014092 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014093
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014094http_date([<offset>])
14095 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14096 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
14097 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
14098 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
14099 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
14100 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014101
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014102in_table(<table>)
14103 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14104 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14105 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014106 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014107 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14108
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014109ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14110 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014111 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014112 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14113 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14114 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14115 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14116 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014117
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014118json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014119 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014120 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014121 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014122 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14123 of errors:
14124 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14125 bytes, ...)
14126 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14127 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14128
14129 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14130 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14131 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14132 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14133 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14134 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014135 - "ascii" : never fails;
14136 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14137 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014138 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014139 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014140 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14141 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14142
14143 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014144 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014145
14146 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014147 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014148 capture request header user-agent len 150
14149 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014150
14151 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14152 GET / HTTP/1.0
14153 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14154
14155 Output log:
14156 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14157
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014158language(<value>[,<default>])
14159 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14160 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14161 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14162 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14163 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14164 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14165 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14166 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14167 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014168 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014169 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14170 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014171
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014172 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014173
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014174 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14175 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014176
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014177 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14178 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14179 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14180 use_backend spanish if es
14181 use_backend french if fr
14182 use_backend english if en
14183 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014184
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014185length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014186 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14187 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14188 type. The result is of type integer.
14189
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014190lower
14191 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14192 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14193 type. The result is of type string.
14194
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014195ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14196 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14197 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14198 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14199 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14200 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14201 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14202
14203 Example :
14204
14205 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014206 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014207 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14208
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014209map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14210map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14211map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14212 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14213 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14214 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14215 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14216 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14217 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14218 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14219 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014220
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014221 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14222 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14223 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014224
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014225 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014226 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014227
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014228 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14229 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14230 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14231 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014232 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14233 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014234 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14235 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14236 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14237 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14238 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14239 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14240 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14241 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014242 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14243 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14244 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014245 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14246 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14247 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14248 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14249 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014250
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014251 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14252 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14253 the corresponding match text.
14254
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014255 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14256 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14257 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14258 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14259 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014260
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014261 Example :
14262
14263 # this is a comment and is ignored
14264 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14265 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14266 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14267 | | | `---------- value
14268 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14269 | `---------------------------- key
14270 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14271
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014272mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014273 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14274 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014275 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014276 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014277 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014278 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14279 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14280 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14281 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014282 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014283 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014284
14285mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014286 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014287 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14288 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014289 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014290 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014291 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014292 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14293 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14294 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14295 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014296 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014297 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014298
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014299nbsrv
14300 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14301 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14302 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14303 map lookup.
14304
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014305neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014306 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14307 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14308 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14309 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014310
14311not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014312 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014313 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014314 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014315 absence of a flag).
14316
14317odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014318 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014319 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14320
14321or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014322 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014323 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014324 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14325 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014326 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014327 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14328 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14329 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14330 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014331 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014332 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014333
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014334protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14335 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14336 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14337 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14338 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14339 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14340 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14341 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14342 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14343 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14344 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14345 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14346
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014347regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014348 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14349 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14350 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14351 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14352 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14353 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14354 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14355 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14356 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
14357 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010014358 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
14359 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
14360 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
14361 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014362
14363 Example :
14364
14365 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14366 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14367 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14368 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14369
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014370capture-req(<id>)
14371 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14372 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14373
14374 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014375 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14376 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014377
14378capture-res(<id>)
14379 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14380 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14381
14382 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014383 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14384 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014385
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014386sdbm([<avalanche>])
14387 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14388 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14389 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14390 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14391 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14392 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14393 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014394 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14395 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014396
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014397set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014398 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14399 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14400 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014401 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014402 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14403 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014404 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014405 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14406 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014407 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014408 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014409
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014410sha1
14411 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
14412 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14413
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014414strcmp(<var>)
14415 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14416 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14417 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14418 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14419 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14420 shorter).
14421
14422 Example :
14423
14424 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14425 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14426 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14427
14428
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014429sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014430 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14431 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014432 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014433 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14434 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014435 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014436 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14437 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014438 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014439 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14440 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014441 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014442 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014443
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014444table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14445 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14446 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14447 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14448 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14449 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14450 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14451
14452
14453table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14454 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14455 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14456 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14457 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14458 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14459 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14460
14461table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14462 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14463 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014464 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014465 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14466 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14467
14468table_conn_cur(<table>)
14469 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14470 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14471 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14472 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14473 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14474
14475table_conn_rate(<table>)
14476 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14477 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14478 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14479 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14480 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14481
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014482table_gpt0(<table>)
14483 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14484 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14485 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14486 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14487 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14488
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014489table_gpc0(<table>)
14490 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14491 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14492 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14493 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14494 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14495
14496table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14497 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14498 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14499 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14500 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14501 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14502 sample fetch keyword.
14503
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014504table_gpc1(<table>)
14505 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14506 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14507 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14508 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14509 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14510
14511table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14512 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14513 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14514 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14515 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14516 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14517 sample fetch keyword.
14518
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014519table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14520 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14521 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014522 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014523 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14524 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14525
14526table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14527 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14528 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14529 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14530 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14531 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14532 keyword.
14533
14534table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14535 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14536 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014537 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014538 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14539 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14540
14541table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14542 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14543 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14544 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14545 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14546 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14547 keyword.
14548
14549table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14550 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14551 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014552 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014553 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14554 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14555 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14556 keyword.
14557
14558table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14559 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14560 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014561 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014562 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14563 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14564 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14565 keyword.
14566
14567table_server_id(<table>)
14568 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14569 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14570 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14571 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14572 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14573 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14574
14575table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14576 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14577 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014578 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014579 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14580 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14581 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14582 keyword.
14583
14584table_sess_rate(<table>)
14585 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14586 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14587 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14588 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14589 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14590 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14591 keyword.
14592
14593table_trackers(<table>)
14594 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14595 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14596 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14597 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14598 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14599 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14600 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14601 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14602 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14603 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14604
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014605upper
14606 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14607 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14608 type. The result is of type string.
14609
Willy Tarreau7e913cb2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020014610url_dec([<in_form>])
14611 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
14612 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
14613 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
14614 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
14615 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
14616 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014617
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014618ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014619 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014620 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14621 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14622 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014623 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14624 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14625 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14626 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014627 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014628 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14629 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014630
14631 Example:
14632 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14633 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14634
14635 message Point {
14636 int32 latitude = 1;
14637 int32 longitude = 2;
14638 }
14639
14640 message PPoint {
14641 Point point = 59;
14642 }
14643
14644 message Rectangle {
14645 // One corner of the rectangle.
14646 PPoint lo = 48;
14647 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14648 PPoint hi = 49;
14649 }
14650
14651 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14652 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14653 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14654
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014655 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14656 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014657 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014658 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14659
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014660 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014661
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014662 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014663
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014664 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014665 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14666 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14667
14668 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14669 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14670 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14671
14672 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14673 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14674 interpret the previous binary sample.
14675
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014676
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014677unset-var(<var name>)
14678 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14679 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14680 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14681 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14682 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14683 response),
14684 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14685 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14686 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14687 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14688
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014689utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14690 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14691 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14692 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14693 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14694 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14695 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14696
14697 Example :
14698
14699 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014700 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014701 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14702
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014703word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14704 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14705 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14706 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnind1fa5fa2020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014707 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014708 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14709 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14710
14711 Example :
14712 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14713 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14714 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14715 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14716 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnind1fa5fa2020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014717 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014718
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014719wt6([<avalanche>])
14720 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14721 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14722 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14723 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14724 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14725 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14726 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014727 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14728 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014729
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014730xor(<value>)
14731 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014732 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014733 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014734 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014735 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014736 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14737 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014738 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014739 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14740 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014741 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014742 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014743
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014744xxh32([<seed>])
14745 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14746 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14747 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14748 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14749 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14750 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14751 as cryptographically secure.
14752
14753xxh64([<seed>])
14754 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14755 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14756 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14757 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14758 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14759 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14760 as cryptographically secure.
14761
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014762
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200147637.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014764--------------------------------------------
14765
14766A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14767not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14768"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14769The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14770
14771always_false : boolean
14772 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14773 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14774
14775always_true : boolean
14776 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14777 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14778
14779avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014780 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014781 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14782 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14783 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14784 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14785 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14786 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14787 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14788 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14789 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14790 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14791 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14792 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14793 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014795be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014796 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14797 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14798 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14799 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014800 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14801
14802be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14803 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14804 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14805 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14806 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14807 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014808 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14809 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014810
14811 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14812 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14813 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014815be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14816 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14817 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14818 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014819 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014820 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14821 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014822
14823 Example :
14824 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14825 backend dynamic
14826 mode http
14827 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14828 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014829
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014830bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014831 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14832 of the string.
14833
14834bool(<bool>) : bool
14835 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14836 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014838connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14839 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014840 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014841 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14842 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014843
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014844 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014845 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014846 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14847
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014848 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14849 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014850
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014851 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014852 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014853 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014854 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014855 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014856 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014857 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014858
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014859 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14860 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014861 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014862 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014863
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014864cpu_calls : integer
14865 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14866 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14867 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14868 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14869 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14870 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14871
14872cpu_ns_avg : integer
14873 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14874 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14875 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14876 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14877 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14878 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14879 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14880 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14881 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14882 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14883 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14884
14885cpu_ns_tot : integer
14886 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14887 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14888 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14889 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14890 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14891 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14892 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14893 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14894 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14895 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14896 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14897 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14898 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14899
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014900date([<offset>]) : integer
14901 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14902 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14903 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14904 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014905 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14906
14907 Example :
14908
14909 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14910 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014911
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014912date_us : integer
14913 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14914 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14915 from the same timeval structure.
14916
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014917distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14918 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14919 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14920 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14921 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14922 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14923 list of supported tokens.
14924
14925distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14926 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14927 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14928 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14929 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14930 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14931 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14932 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14933 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14934 supported tokens.
14935
14936 Example :
14937 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14938 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14939 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14940 # send large files to the big farm
14941 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14942
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014943env(<name>) : string
14944 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14945 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14946 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14947 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14948 certain way.
14949
14950 Examples :
14951 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14952 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14953
14954 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14955 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014957fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14958 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014959 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14960 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014961 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14962 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014963 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014964 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14965 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014966
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014967fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14968 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14969 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14970 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014972fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14973 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14974 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14975 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14976 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14977 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14978 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14979 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14980 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014981
14982 Example :
14983 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14984 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14985 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14986 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14987 frontend mail
14988 bind :25
14989 mode tcp
14990 maxconn 100
14991 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14992 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14993 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14994 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014995
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014996hostname : string
14997 Returns the system hostname.
14998
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014999int(<integer>) : signed integer
15000 Returns a signed integer.
15001
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015002ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15003 Returns an ipv4.
15004
15005ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15006 Returns an ipv6.
15007
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015008lat_ns_avg : integer
15009 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15010 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15011 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15012 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15013 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15014 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15015 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15016 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15017 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15018 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15019 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15020 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15021 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
15022 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15023
15024lat_ns_tot : integer
15025 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15026 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15027 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15028 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15029 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15030 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15031 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15032 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15033 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15034 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15035 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15036 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15037 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
15038 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15039 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15040 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15041 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15042 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15043 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15044
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015045meth(<method>) : method
15046 Returns a method.
15047
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015048nbproc : integer
15049 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15050 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15051 and debugging purposes.
15052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015053nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15054 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15055 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15056 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015057 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15058 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15059 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015060
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015061prio_class : integer
15062 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15063 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15064 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15065
15066prio_offset : integer
15067 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15068 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15069 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15070 set-priority-offset".
15071
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015072proc : integer
15073 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15074 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15075 debugging purposes.
15076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015077queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015078 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15079 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15080 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015081 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15082 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15083 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15084 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15085 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15086
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015087rand([<range>]) : integer
15088 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15089 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15090 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15091 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15092 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15093
Luca Schimweg77306662019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015094uuid([<version>]) : string
15095 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15096 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15097 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015099srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15100 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15101 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15102 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15103 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15104 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015105 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15106 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15107
15108srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15109 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15110 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15111 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15112 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15113 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15114 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15115 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15116
15117 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15118 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015119
15120srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15121 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15122 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15123 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015124 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015125 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15126 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15127 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15128
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015129srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15130 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15131 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15132 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15133 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15134 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15135 fetch methods.
15136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015137srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15138 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15139 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015140 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015141 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15142 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015143 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015144 overloading servers).
15145
15146 Example :
15147 # Redirect to a separate back
15148 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15149 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15150 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15151
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015152stopping : boolean
15153 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15154 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15155 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15156
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015157str(<string>) : string
15158 Returns a string.
15159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015160table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15161 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15162 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15163
15164table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15165 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15166 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15167 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15168
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015169thread : integer
15170 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15171 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15172 and debugging purposes.
15173
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015174var(<var-name>) : undefined
15175 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015176 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15177 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015178 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015179 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15180 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015181 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015182 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15183 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015184 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015185 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015186
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015188----------------------------------
15189
15190The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15191closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15192methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15193sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15194TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015195the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15196counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015197"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15198used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15199can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15200Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15201table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15202tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15203currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015204
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015205bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015206 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15207 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15208 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015210be_id : integer
15211 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15212 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15213
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015214be_name : string
15215 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15216 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015218dst : ip
15219 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15220 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15221 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15222 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015223 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15224 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15225 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15226 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15227 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15228 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015229
15230dst_conn : integer
15231 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15232 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15233 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15234 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15235 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15236 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15237 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15238 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015239
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015240dst_is_local : boolean
15241 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15242 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15243 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15244 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015245 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015246 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15247 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15248 it only once per connection.
15249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015250dst_port : integer
15251 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15252 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15253 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15254 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15255 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15256 an HTTP header.
15257
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015258fc_http_major : integer
15259 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15260 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15261 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15262
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015263fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15264 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15265 header.
15266
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015267fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15268 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15269 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15270 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15271 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15272 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15273 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15274
15275fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15276 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15277 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15278 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15279 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15280 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15281 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15282
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015283fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015284 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15285 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15286 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15287 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15288
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015289fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015290 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15291 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15292 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15293 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15294
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015295fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015296 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15297 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15298 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15299 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15300
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015301fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015302 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15303 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15304 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15305 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15306
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015307fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015308 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15309 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15310 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15311 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15312
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015313fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015314 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15315 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15316 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15317 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15318
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015319fe_defbe : string
15320 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15321 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015323fe_id : integer
15324 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015325 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015326 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15327
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015328fe_name : string
15329 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15330 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15331 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15332
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015333sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015334sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15335sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15336sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015337 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15338 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15339 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15340
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015341sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015342sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15343sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15344sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015345 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15346 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15347 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15348
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015349sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015350sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15351sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15352sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015353 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15354 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015355 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15356 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15357 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015358
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015359 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015360 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15361 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015362 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15363 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15364 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015365 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15366 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15367
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015368sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15369sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15370sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15371sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15372 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15373 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15374 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15375 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15376 when a first ACL was verified.
15377
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015378sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015379sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15380sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15381sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015382 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015383 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15384
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015385sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015386sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15387sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15388sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015389 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15390 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15391 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15392
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015393sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015394sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15395sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15396sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015397 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15398 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15399 See also src_conn_rate.
15400
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015401sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015402sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15403sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15404sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015405 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015406 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015407
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015408sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15409sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15410sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15411sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15412 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15413 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15414
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015415sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15416sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15417sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15418sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15419 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15420 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15421
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015422sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015423sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15424sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15425sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015426 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15427 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15428 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015429 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15430 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15431 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015432
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015433sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15434sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15435sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15436sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15437 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15438 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15439 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15440 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15441 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15442 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15443
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015444sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015445sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15446sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15447sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015448 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015449 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15450 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15451
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015452sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015453sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15454sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15455sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015456 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15457 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15458 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15459 src_http_err_rate.
15460
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015461sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015462sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15463sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15464sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015465 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015466 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15467 src_http_req_cnt.
15468
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015469sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015470sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15471sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15472sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015473 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15474 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15475 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15476 src_http_req_rate.
15477
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015478sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015479sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15480sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15481sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015482 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015483 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15484 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15485 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15486 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015487
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015488 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015489 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15490 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015491 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15492
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015493sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15494sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15495sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15496sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15497 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15498 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15499 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15500 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15501 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15502
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015503sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015504sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15505sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15506sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015507 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15508 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15509 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015510
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015511sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015512sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15513sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15514sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015515 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15516 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15517 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015518
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015519sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015520sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15521sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15522sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015523 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015524 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15525 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15526 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015527 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015528 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15529
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015530sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015531sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15532sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15533sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015534 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15535 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15536 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15537 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15538 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015539 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015540
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015541sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015542sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15543sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15544sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015545 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15546 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15547 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15548
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015549sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015550sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15551sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15552sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015553 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15554 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015555 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015556 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15557 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015558 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15559 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15560 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015562so_id : integer
15563 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15564 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15565 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015566
Jerome Magnin28b90332020-03-27 22:08:40 +010015567so_name : string
15568 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
15569 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
15570 strings instead of integers.
15571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015572src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015573 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015574 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15575 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15576 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015577 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15578 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15579 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015580 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15581 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15582 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15583 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15584 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15585 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15586 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015587
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015588 Example:
15589 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15590 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015592src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15593 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15594 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15595 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015596 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015598src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15599 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15600 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015601 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015602 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015604src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15605 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15606 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15607 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15608 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15609 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15610 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015611
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015612 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015613 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15614 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15615 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15616 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015617 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015618 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15619 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15620
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015621src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15622 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15623 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15624 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15625 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15626 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15627 was verified.
15628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015629src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015630 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015631 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015632 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015633 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015635src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015636 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015637 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15638 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015639 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015641src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15642 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15643 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15644 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015645 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015647src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015648 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015649 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015650 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015651 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015652
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015653src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15654 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15655 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15656 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15657 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15658
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015659src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15660 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15661 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15662 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15663 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015665src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015666 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015667 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015668 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15669 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015670 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15671 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15672 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015673
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015674src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15675 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15676 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15677 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15678 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15679 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15680 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15681 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015683src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015684 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015685 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015686 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015687 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015688 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015690src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15691 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15692 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15693 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15694 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015695 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015697src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015698 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15700 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015701 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015703src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15704 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15705 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15706 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015707 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015708 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015710src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15711 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15712 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15713 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015714 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15716 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015717
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015718 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015719 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015720 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015721 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015722
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015723src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15724 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15725 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15726 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15727 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15728 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15729 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15730
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015731src_is_local : boolean
15732 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15733 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15734 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15735 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015736 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015737 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15738 once per connection.
15739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015740src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015741 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15742 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15743 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15744 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15745 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015747src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015748 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15749 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15750 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15751 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15752 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015754src_port : integer
15755 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15756 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15757 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15758 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015760src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015761 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015762 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15763 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15764 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015765 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015767src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15768 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15769 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15770 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15771 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015772 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015774src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15775 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15776 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15777 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15778 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15779 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15780 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15781 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15782 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015783
15784 Example :
15785 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15786 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15787 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15788 listen ssh
15789 bind :22
15790 mode tcp
15791 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015792 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015793 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015794 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015796srv_id : integer
15797 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15798 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15799 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015800
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158017.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015802----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015804The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15805closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15806when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15807usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015808future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015809
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001581051d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15811 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15812 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15813 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15814 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15815 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15816
15817 Example :
15818 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15819 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15820 # the request.
15821 frontend http-in
15822 bind *:8081
15823 default_backend servers
15824 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15825 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15826
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015827ssl_bc : boolean
15828 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15829 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15830 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15831
15832ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15833 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15834 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15835
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015836ssl_bc_alpn : string
15837 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15838 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015839 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015840 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15841 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15842 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15843 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15844 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15845 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15846
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015847ssl_bc_cipher : string
15848 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15849 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15850
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015851ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15852 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15853 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15854 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15855
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015856ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15857 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15858 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15859 session or a TLS ticket.
15860
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015861ssl_bc_npn : string
15862 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15863 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015864 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015865 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15866 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15867 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15868 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15869 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15870
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015871ssl_bc_protocol : string
15872 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15873 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15874
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015875ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015876 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015877 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15878 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015879
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015880ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15881 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15882 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15883 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15884
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015885ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15886 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15887 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15888 if session was reused or not.
15889
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015890ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15891 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15892 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15893 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15894 BoringSSL.
15895
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015896ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15897 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15898 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015900ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15901 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15902 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15903 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15904 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15905 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015907ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15908 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15909 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15910 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15911 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015912
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015913ssl_c_der : binary
15914 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15915 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15916 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015918ssl_c_err : integer
15919 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15920 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15921 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15922 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15923 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015925ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15926 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15927 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15928 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15929 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15930 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15931 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15932 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15933 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015935ssl_c_key_alg : string
15936 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15937 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15938 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015940ssl_c_notafter : string
15941 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15942 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15943 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015945ssl_c_notbefore : string
15946 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15947 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15948 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015950ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15951 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15952 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15953 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15954 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15955 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15956 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15957 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15958 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015960ssl_c_serial : binary
15961 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15962 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15963 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015965ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15966 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15967 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15968 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015969 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15970 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15971
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015972 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015973 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015975ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15976 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15977 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15978 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015980ssl_c_used : boolean
15981 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15982 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015984ssl_c_verify : integer
15985 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15986 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15987 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15988 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015990ssl_c_version : integer
15991 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15992 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015993
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015994ssl_f_der : binary
15995 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15996 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15997 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015999ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
16000 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16001 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16002 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16003 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016004 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016005 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16006 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16007 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016009ssl_f_key_alg : string
16010 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16011 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16012 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016014ssl_f_notafter : string
16015 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16016 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16017 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016019ssl_f_notbefore : string
16020 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16021 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16022 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016024ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
16025 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16026 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16027 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16028 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16029 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16030 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16031 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16032 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016034ssl_f_serial : binary
16035 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16036 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16037 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016038
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016039ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16040 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16041 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16042 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016044ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16045 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16046 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16047 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016049ssl_f_version : integer
16050 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16051 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16052
16053ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016054 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16055 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16056 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016058 Example :
16059 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16060 listen http-https
16061 bind :80
16062 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16063 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16064
16065ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16066 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16067 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16068
16069ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016070 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016071 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16072 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16073 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16074 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16075 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16076 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16077 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16078 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016080ssl_fc_cipher : string
16081 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16082 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016083
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016084ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16085 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16086 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016087 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016088
16089ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16090 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16091 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016092 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016093
16094ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16095 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16096 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16097 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016098 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016099 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016100
16101ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16102 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16103 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016104 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016105
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016106ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16107 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16108 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16109 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016111ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016112 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16113 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016114 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16115 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16116 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16117 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016118
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016119ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16120 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16121 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16122 wait until the handshake happened.
16123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016124ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16125 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016126 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16127 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016128 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016129 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016130
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016131ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016132 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016133 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16134 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016136ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016137 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016138 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16139 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16140 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16141 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16142 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16143 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16144 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016146ssl_fc_protocol : string
16147 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16148 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016149
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016150ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016151 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016152 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16153 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016154
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016155ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16156 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16157 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16158 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016160ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16161 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16162 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16163 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16164 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016165
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016166ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16167 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16168 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16169 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16170 BoringSSL.
16171
16172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016173ssl_fc_sni : string
16174 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16175 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16176 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16177 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16178 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16179
16180 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16181 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16182 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016183 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016184 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016186 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016187 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16188 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016190ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16191 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16192 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016193
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016194
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161957.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016196------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016198Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16199sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16200only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16201For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16202be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16203can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16204sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16205for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16206content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016208payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016209 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016210 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16211 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016213payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16214 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016215 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016216 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016218req.len : integer
16219req_len : integer (deprecated)
16220 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16221 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16222 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16223 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16224 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16225 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16226 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16227 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016229req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16230 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016231 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16232 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16233 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16234 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016236 ACL alternatives :
16237 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016239req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16240 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16241 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16242 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16243 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016245 ACL alternatives :
16246 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016248 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016250req.proto_http : boolean
16251req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16252 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16253 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16254 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16255 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16256 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16257 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16258 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016260 Example:
16261 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16262 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16263 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016264 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016266req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16267rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16268 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16269 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16270 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16271 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16272 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16273 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16274 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016276 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16277 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16278 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16279 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16280 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16281 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016283 ACL derivatives :
16284 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016286 Example :
16287 listen tse-farm
16288 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16289 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16290 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16291 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16292 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16293 persist rdp-cookie
16294 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16295 # This is only useful makes sense if
16296 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16297 stick-table type string size 204800
16298 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16299 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16300 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016302 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16303 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016305req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16306rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16307 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16308 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16309 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16310 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016312 ACL derivatives :
16313 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016314
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016315req.ssl_alpn : string
16316 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16317 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16318 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16319 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16320 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16321 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016322 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016323
16324 Examples :
16325 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16326 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16327 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016328 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016329 default_backend bk_default
16330
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016331req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16332 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16333 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016334 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16335 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16336 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16337 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16338 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016340req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16341req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16342 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16343 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16344 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16345 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16346 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16347 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16348 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016350req.ssl_sni : string
16351req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16352 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16353 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16354 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16355 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16356 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16357 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16358 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16359 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16360 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16361 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16362 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16363 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016365 ACL derivatives :
16366 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016368 Examples :
16369 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16370 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16371 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16372 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16373 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016374
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016375req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16376 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16377 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16378 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16379 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16380 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16381 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16382 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16383 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16384 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016386req.ssl_ver : integer
16387req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16388 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16389 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16390 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16391 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16392 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16393 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16394 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016395 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016396 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016398 ACL derivatives :
16399 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016400
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016401res.len : integer
16402 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16403 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16404 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16405 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16406 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16407 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16408 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16409 content inspection.
16410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016411res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16412 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016413 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16414 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16415 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16416 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016418res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16419 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16420 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16421 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16422 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016424 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016425
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016426res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16427rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16428 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16429 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16430 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16431 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16432 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16433 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16434 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016436wait_end : boolean
16437 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16438 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016439 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016440 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16441 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016442 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016443 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16444 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016446 Examples :
16447 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16448 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16449 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016451 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16452 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16453 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16454 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16455 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16456 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16457 tcp-request content reject
16458
16459
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200164607.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016461--------------------------------------
16462
16463It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16464This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16465data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16466its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16467HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16468content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16469to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16470more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16471response are indexed.
16472
16473base : string
16474 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16475 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16476 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16477 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16478 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16479 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16480 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16481 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16482
16483 ACL derivatives :
16484 base : exact string match
16485 base_beg : prefix match
16486 base_dir : subdir match
16487 base_dom : domain match
16488 base_end : suffix match
16489 base_len : length match
16490 base_reg : regex match
16491 base_sub : substring match
16492
16493base32 : integer
16494 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16495 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16496 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016497 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16498 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16499 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016500
16501base32+src : binary
16502 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16503 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16504 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16505 per-URL counters.
16506
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016507capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16508 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16509 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16510 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16511
16512capture.req.method : string
16513 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16514 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16515 because it's allocated.
16516
16517capture.req.uri : string
16518 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16519 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16520 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16521 allocated.
16522
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016523capture.req.ver : string
16524 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16525 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16526 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16527
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016528capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16529 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16530 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16531 The first entry is an index of 0.
16532 See also: "capture response header"
16533
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016534capture.res.ver : string
16535 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16536 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16537 persistent flag.
16538
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016539req.body : binary
16540 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16541 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16542 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16543 the first chunk is analyzed.
16544
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016545req.body_param([<name>) : string
16546 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16547 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16548 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16549 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16550 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16551 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16552 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16553 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16554 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16555 given.
16556
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016557req.body_len : integer
16558 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16559 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16560 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16561 "option http-buffer-request".
16562
16563req.body_size : integer
16564 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16565 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16566 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16567 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16568 "option http-buffer-request".
16569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016570req.cook([<name>]) : string
16571cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16572 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16573 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16574 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16575 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16576 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16577 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16578 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16579 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16580
16581 ACL derivatives :
16582 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16583 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16584 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16585 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16586 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16587 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16588 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16589 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016591req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16592cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16593 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16594 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016596req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16597cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16598 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16599 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16600 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16601 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016603cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16604 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16605 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16606 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16607 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016608 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016609 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16610 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16611 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16612 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016614hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16615 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16616 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16617 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16618 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016619 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016621req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16622 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16623 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16624 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16625 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16626 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16627 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16628 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16629 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016631req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16632 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16633 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16634 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16635 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016637req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16638 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16639 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16640 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16641 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16642 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16643 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16644 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16645 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016646 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016647 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016648 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016650 ACL derivatives :
16651 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16652 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16653 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16654 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16655 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16656 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16657 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16658 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16659
16660req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16661hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16662 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16663 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16664 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16665 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16666 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16667 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16668 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16669 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16670 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16671
16672req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16673hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16674 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16675 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16676 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreaud08feaf2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010016677 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
16678 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
16679 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
16680 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
16681 cause the address to be ignored. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016682 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016683 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016684 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16685 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16686
16687req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16688hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16689 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16690 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16691 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16692 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16693 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16694 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16695 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16696
Christopher Faulet5be59a92020-11-24 17:13:24 +010016697req.hdrs : string
16698 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16699 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16700 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16701 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16702
16703req.hdrs_bin : binary
16704 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16705 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16706 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16707 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16708 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16709 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16710
16711 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016712
Christopher Faulet5be59a92020-11-24 17:13:24 +010016713 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16714 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016716http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16717 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16718 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16719 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16720 basic auth is supported.
16721
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016722http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16723 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16724 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16725 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16726 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016727 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16728 basic auth is supported.
16729
16730 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016731 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16732 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16733 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16734 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016735
16736http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016737 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16738 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016739 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16740 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016742method : integer + string
16743 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16744 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16745 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16746 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16747 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16748 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16749 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016751 ACL derivatives :
16752 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016754 Example :
16755 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16756 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16757 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016759path : string
16760 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16761 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16762 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16763 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16764 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016765 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016766 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016768 ACL derivatives :
16769 path : exact string match
16770 path_beg : prefix match
16771 path_dir : subdir match
16772 path_dom : domain match
16773 path_end : suffix match
16774 path_len : length match
16775 path_reg : regex match
16776 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016777
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016778query : string
16779 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16780 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16781 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16782 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016783 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016784 which stops before the question mark.
16785
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016786req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16787 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16788 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16789 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16790 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016792req.ver : string
16793req_ver : string (deprecated)
16794 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16795 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16796 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016798 ACL derivatives :
16799 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016801res.comp : boolean
16802 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16803 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16804 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016806res.comp_algo : string
16807 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16808 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16809 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016811res.cook([<name>]) : string
16812scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16813 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16814 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16815 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016817 ACL derivatives :
16818 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016820res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16821scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16822 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16823 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16824 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016826res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16827scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16828 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16829 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16830 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016832res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16833 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16834 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16835 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16836 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16837 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16838 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16839 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16840 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16841 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016843res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16844 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16845 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16846 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16847 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16848 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016850res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16851shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16852 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16853 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16854 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16855 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16856 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16857 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16858 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16859 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016861 ACL derivatives :
16862 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16863 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16864 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16865 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16866 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16867 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16868 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16869 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16870
16871res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16872shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16873 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16874 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16875 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16876 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16877 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016879res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16880shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16881 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16882 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16883 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16884 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16885 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16886 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016887
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016888res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16889 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16890 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16891 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16892 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016894res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16895shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16896 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16897 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16898 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16899 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16900 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16901 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016903res.ver : string
16904resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16905 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16906 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016908 ACL derivatives :
16909 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016911set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16912 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16913 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016914 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016915 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016917 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16918 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016920status : integer
16921 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16922 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16923 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016924
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016925unique-id : string
16926 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16927 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16928 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16929 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16930 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16931 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016933url : string
16934 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16935 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16936 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16937 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16938 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16939 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16940 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016942 ACL derivatives :
16943 url : exact string match
16944 url_beg : prefix match
16945 url_dir : subdir match
16946 url_dom : domain match
16947 url_end : suffix match
16948 url_len : length match
16949 url_reg : regex match
16950 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016952url_ip : ip
16953 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16954 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16955 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16956 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16957 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16958 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16959 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016961url_port : integer
16962 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16963 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16964 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16965 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016966
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016967urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16968url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016969 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16970 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016971 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16972 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16973 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16974 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016975 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16976 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016977 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16978 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016980 ACL derivatives :
16981 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16982 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16983 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16984 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16985 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16986 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16987 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16988 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016989
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016991 Example :
16992 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16993 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16994 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16995 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016996
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016997urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016998 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16999 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
17000 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020017001
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020017002url32 : integer
17003 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
17004 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
17005 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
17006 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
17007 is an unsigned integer.
17008
17009url32+src : binary
17010 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
17011 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
17012 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
17013
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010017014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200170157.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017016---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017018Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
17019every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020017020order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017021
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017022ACL name Equivalent to Usage
17023---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017024FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020017025HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017026HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
17027HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017028HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
17029HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
17030HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
17031HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
17032LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017033METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017034METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017035METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
17036METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
17037METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
17038METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017039METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017040METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017041RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017042REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017043TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017044WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17045---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017046
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170488. Logging
17049----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017050
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017051One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17052provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17053very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17054provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17055state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017056to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017057headers.
17058
17059In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17060about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17061send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17062
17063 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17064 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17065 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17066 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17067 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017068 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017069 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017070
17071The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17072allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17073as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17074while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17075real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17076delay.
17077
17078
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170798.1. Log levels
17080---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017081
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017082TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017083source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017084HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17085in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17086track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17087syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17088about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017089
17090
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170918.2. Log formats
17092----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017093
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017094HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017095and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17096slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17097options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017098
17099 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17100 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17101 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17102 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17103 extents.
17104
17105 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17106 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17107 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17108 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17109 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17110
17111 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17112 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17113 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17114 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17115 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17116
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017117 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17118 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17119 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17120 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17121
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017122 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17123
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017124Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17125specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17126field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17127servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17128always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17129identifier.
17130
17131Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17132 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17133 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17134 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17135 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17136
17137
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171388.2.1. Default log format
17139-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017140
17141This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17142as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17143format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17144
17145 Example :
17146 listen www
17147 mode http
17148 log global
17149 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17150
17151 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17152 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17153 (www/HTTP)
17154
17155 Field Format Extract from the example above
17156 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17157 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17158 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17159 4 'to' to
17160 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17161 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17162
17163Detailed fields description :
17164 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17165 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17166 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17167 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17168 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17169 and processed the connection.
17170 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17171
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017172In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17173"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17174connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17175
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017176It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17177will eventually disappear.
17178
17179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171808.2.2. TCP log format
17181---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017182
17183The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17184is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17185information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17186counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17187emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17188environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17189the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17190sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017191specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17192not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17193fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17194marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017195
17196 Example :
17197 frontend fnt
17198 mode tcp
17199 option tcplog
17200 log global
17201 default_backend bck
17202
17203 backend bck
17204 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17205
17206 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17207 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17208 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17209
17210 Field Format Extract from the example above
17211 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17212 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17213 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17214 4 frontend_name fnt
17215 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17216 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17217 7 bytes_read* 212
17218 8 termination_state --
17219 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17220 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17221
17222Detailed fields description :
17223 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017224 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17225 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17226 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017227 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017228 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017229 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017230
17231 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017232 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17233 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17234 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017235
17236 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17237 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17238 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017239 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17240 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17241 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17242 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017243
17244 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17245 and processed the connection.
17246
17247 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17248 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17249 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17250 applications.
17251
17252 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17253 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17254 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17255 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17256 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17257
17258 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17259 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17260 See "Timers" below for more details.
17261
17262 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17263 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17264 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17265 "Timers" below for more details.
17266
17267 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017268 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017269 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17270 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17271 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17272 details.
17273
17274 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17275 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17276 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17277 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17278 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17279
17280 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17281 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17282 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17283 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17284 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17285 for more details.
17286
17287 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017288 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017289 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17290 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17291 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017292 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017293
17294 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17295 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17296 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17297 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17298 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17299 caused by a denial of service attack.
17300
17301 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17302 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17303 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17304 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17305 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17306 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17307 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17308 denial of service attack.
17309
17310 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17311 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17312 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17313 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17314 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17315 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17316 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17317 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17318 be processed than on other servers.
17319
17320 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17321 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17322 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17323 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17324 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17325 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17326 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17327 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17328 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17329 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17330 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17331 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17332 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17333
17334 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17335 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17336 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17337 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17338 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17339 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017340 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017341 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17342
17343 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17344 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17345 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17346 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17347 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17348 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017349 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017350 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17351 occurs.
17352
17353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173548.2.3. HTTP log format
17355----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017356
17357The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17358is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17359the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17360are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17361emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17362generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17363"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17364which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017365frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17366is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017367
17368Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17369slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17370with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17371
17372 Example :
17373 frontend http-in
17374 mode http
17375 option httplog
17376 log global
17377 default_backend bck
17378
17379 backend static
17380 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17381
17382 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17383 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17384 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017385 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017386
17387 Field Format Extract from the example above
17388 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17389 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017390 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017391 4 frontend_name http-in
17392 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017393 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017394 7 status_code 200
17395 8 bytes_read* 2750
17396 9 captured_request_cookie -
17397 10 captured_response_cookie -
17398 11 termination_state ----
17399 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17400 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17401 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17402 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17403 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017404
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017405Detailed fields description :
17406 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017407 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17408 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17409 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017410 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017411 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017412 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017413
17414 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017415 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17416 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17417 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017418
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017419 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17420 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017421
17422 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17423 and processed the connection.
17424
17425 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17426 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17427 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17428
17429 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17430 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17431 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17432 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17433 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17434 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17435
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017436 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17437 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17438 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017439 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017440 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17441 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017442 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17443 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017444
17445 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17446 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017447 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017448
17449 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17450 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017451 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17452 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017453
17454 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17455 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17456 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17457 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17458 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017459 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17460 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017461
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017462 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17463 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17464 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17465 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17466 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17467 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17468 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017469 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017470
17471 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17472 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17473 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17474
17475 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17476 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017477 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017478 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17479 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17480 overflowing.
17481
17482 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17483 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17484 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17485 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17486 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17487 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17488 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17489 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17490
17491 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17492 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17493 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17494 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17495 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17496 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17497 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17498 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17499
17500 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17501 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17502 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17503 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17504 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17505 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17506 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17507
17508 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017509 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017510 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17511 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17512 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017513 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017514 system.
17515
17516 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17517 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17518 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17519 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17520 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17521 caused by a denial of service attack.
17522
17523 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17524 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17525 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17526 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17527 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17528 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17529 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17530 denial of service attack.
17531
17532 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17533 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17534 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17535 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17536 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17537 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17538 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17539 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17540 processed than on other servers.
17541
17542 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17543 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17544 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17545 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17546 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17547 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17548 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17549 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17550 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17551 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17552 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17553 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17554 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17555
17556 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17557 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17558 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17559 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17560 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17561 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017562 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017563 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17564
17565 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17566 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17567 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17568 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17569 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17570 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017571 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017572 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17573 occurs.
17574
17575 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17576 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17577 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17578 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17579 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17580 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17581 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17582 cookies" below for more details.
17583
17584 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17585 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17586 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17587 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17588 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17589 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17590 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17591 and cookies" below for more details.
17592
17593 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17594 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17595 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17596 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17597 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17598 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17599 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17600 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17601
17602
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200176038.2.4. Custom log format
17604------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017605
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017606The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017607mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017608
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017609HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017610Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17611separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17612prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17613
17614Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17615variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017616("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017617
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017618If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017619as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017620less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17621the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17622
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017623Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017624In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017625in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017626
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017627Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17628'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17629https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17630such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17631
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017632Flags are :
17633 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017634 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017635 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17636 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017637
17638 Example:
17639
17640 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17641 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17642
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017643 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17644
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017645At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17646
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017647 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17648 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017649
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017650the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017651
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017652 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17653 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17654 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017655
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017656and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17657
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017658 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17659 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017660
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017661Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17662
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017663 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017664 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017665 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17666 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17667 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017668 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17669 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17670 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017671 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017672 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17673 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017674 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017675 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17676 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017677 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017678 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017679 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017680 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017681 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017682 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017683 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017684 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17685 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17686 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17687 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17688 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017689 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017690 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17691 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017692 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017693 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17694 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017695 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17696 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17697 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017698 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017699 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17700 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017701 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017702 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17703 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17704 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017705 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017706 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017707 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17708 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17709 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17710 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017711 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017712 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017713 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017714 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017715 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017716 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017717 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17718 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17719 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017720 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017721 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17722 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017723 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017724 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17725 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017726 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017727 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017728 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017729 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017730
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017731 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017732
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017733
177348.2.5. Error log format
17735-----------------------
17736
17737When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17738protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17739By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17740"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017741will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017742logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17743
17744The format looks like this :
17745
17746 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17747 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17748 Connection error during SSL handshake
17749
17750 Field Format Extract from the example above
17751 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17752 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17753 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17754 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17755 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17756
17757These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17758failures.
17759
17760
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177618.3. Advanced logging options
17762-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017763
17764Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17765just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17766options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17767for more information about their usage.
17768
17769
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177708.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17771------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017772
17773It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17774haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17775commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17776monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17777ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17778
17779 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17780 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17781 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17782 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17783
17784 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17785 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17786 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017787 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017788 such as other load-balancers.
17789
17790 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17791 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17792 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17793
17794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177958.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17796----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017797
17798The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17799what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17800or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017801"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017802just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17803log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17804after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17805is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17806with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17807with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17808
17809
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178108.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17811------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017812
17813Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17814for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17815"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17816retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17817raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17818a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17819file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17820you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17821"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17822
17823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178248.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17825--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017826
17827Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17828multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17829them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17830"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17831logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17832error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17833and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17834too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17835useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17836alternative.
17837
17838
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178398.4. Timing events
17840------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017841
17842Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17843reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17844the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17845frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017846mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17847addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17848
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017849Timings events in HTTP mode:
17850
17851 first request 2nd request
17852 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17853 t tr t tr ...
17854 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17855 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17856 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17857 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17858 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17859
17860Timings events in TCP mode:
17861
17862 TCP session
17863 |<----------------->|
17864 t t
17865 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17866 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17867 |<------ Tt ------->|
17868
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017869 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017870 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017871 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17872 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17873 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017874 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017875 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17876 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17877 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17878 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017879
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017880 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17881 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17882 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017883 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17884 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17885 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17886 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17887 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17888 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017889
17890 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17891 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17892 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17893 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17894 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17895 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17896 request typed by hand during a test.
17897
17898 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17899 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017900 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017901 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17902 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17903 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17904 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017905
17906 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17907 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17908 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17909 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17910 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17911
17912 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17913 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17914 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17915 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17916 connection never established.
17917
17918 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17919 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17920 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17921 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17922 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17923 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17924 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17925 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17926 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17927 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17928 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17929
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017930 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17931 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17932 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17933 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17934 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17935 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17936
17937 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17938
17939 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17940 "Ta" can never be negative.
17941
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017942 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17943 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017944 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17945 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017946 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017947
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017948 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017949
17950 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017951 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17952 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017953
17954These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17955protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17956that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017957due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17958"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17959that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017960
17961Most common cases :
17962
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017963 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17964 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17965 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17966 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17967 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17968 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17969 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17970 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17971 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17972 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17973 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017974 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017975
17976 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17977 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17978 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17979 of ms on remote networks.
17980
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017981 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17982 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17983 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017984
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017985 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17986 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17987 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17988 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17989 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17990 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17991 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17992 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17993 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017994
17995Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17996
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017997 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017998 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017999 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018000
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018001 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018002 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
18003 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
18004
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018005 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018006 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
18007 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
18008 flags.
18009
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018010 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
18011 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018012 Check the session termination flags, then check the
18013 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
18014 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
18015 the client connection was maintained open.
18016
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018017 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018018 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018019 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018020 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
18021
18022
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180238.5. Session state at disconnection
18024-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018025
18026TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
18027"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
180282-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
18029each of which has a special meaning :
18030
18031 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
18032 session to terminate :
18033
18034 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
18035
18036 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
18037 server explicitly refused it.
18038
18039 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
18040 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
18041 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18042 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018043 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018044
18045 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18046 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018047
18048 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18049 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18050 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18051 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18052 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18053
18054 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18055 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18056 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18057 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18058 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18059
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018060 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18061 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18062
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018063 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18064 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18065 backup connections when going up.
18066
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018067 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18068
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018069 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18070 send or receive data.
18071
18072 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18073 send or receive data.
18074
18075 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18076 with nothing left in the buffers.
18077
18078 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18079
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018080 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018081 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18082
18083 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18084 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18085 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18086 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18087 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18088
18089 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18090 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18091
18092 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18093 server (HTTP only).
18094
18095 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18096
18097 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18098 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18099 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18100
18101 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18102 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18103 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18104
18105 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18106
18107 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18108 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18109
18110 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18111 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18112 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18113
18114 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18115 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018116 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18117 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018118
18119 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18120 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18121 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18122 another server.
18123
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018124 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018125 server.
18126
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018127 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18128 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18129 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18130 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18131
18132 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18133 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18134 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18135 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18136
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018137 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18138 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18139 "use-server" rule).
18140
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018141 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18142
18143 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18144 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18145
18146 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18147
18148 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18149 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18150 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18151
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018152 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18153 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018154 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018155 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18156 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18157
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018158 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18159
18160 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18161 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18162
18163 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18164
18165 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18166
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018167The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18168was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018169helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18170starvation, attacks, etc...
18171
18172The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18173alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18174easier finding and understanding.
18175
18176 Flags Reason
18177
18178 -- Normal termination.
18179
18180 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18181 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18182 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18183 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18184
18185 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18186 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18187 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18188 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18189 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18190 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018191
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018192 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18193 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018194 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018195
18196 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18197 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18198 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18199
18200 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18201 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18202 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18203 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18204 the server takes too long to respond.
18205
18206 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18207 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18208 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18209 long a time to respond.
18210
18211 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18212 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18213 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18214 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018215 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18216 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018217
18218 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18219 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18220 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18221 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18222 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018223 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018224 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18225 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18226 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18227 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18228 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18229 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18230 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18231 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018232 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018233 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18234 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18235 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018236
18237 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18238 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018239 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18240 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18241 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18242 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018243
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018244 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18245 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18246
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018247 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018248 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18249 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018250 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018251 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18252 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18253
18254 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18255 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18256 503 or 504 here.
18257
18258 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18259 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18260 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18261 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18262 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18263
18264 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18265 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018266 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018267 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18268 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18269
18270 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18271 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18272 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18273 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18274 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18275 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18276 between haproxy and the server.
18277
18278 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18279 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18280 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18281 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18282 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18283 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18284 solution is to fix the application.
18285
18286 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18287 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18288 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18289 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18290 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18291 external attacks.
18292
18293 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombs31d31f92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070018294 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018295 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018296 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18297 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18298
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018299 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18300 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18301 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018302 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018303 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018304
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018305 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18306 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18307 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18308 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018309 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18310 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18311 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18312 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18313 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018314
18315 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18316 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18317 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18318 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18319
18320 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18321 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18322 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18323 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18324
18325 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18326 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18327 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18328 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18329
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018330The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18331persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18332important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18333re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18334
18335 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18336
18337 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18338 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18339 set on a GET request.
18340
18341 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18342 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018343 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018344 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18345
18346 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18347 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18348 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18349
18350 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18351 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18352 already got a cookie.
18353
18354 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18355 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18356 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18357 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18358 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18359
18360 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18361 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18362 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18363
18364 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18365 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18366 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18367
18368 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18369 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18370
18371 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18372 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18373 then advertised in the response.
18374
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183768.6. Non-printable characters
18377-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018378
18379In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18380consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18381converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18382prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18383being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18384escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18385is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18386'}' when logging headers.
18387
18388Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18389issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18390containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18391
18392Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18393the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18394performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18395
18396
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183978.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18398---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018399
18400Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18401achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018402section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018403cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18404the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18405the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018406locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018407not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18408user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18409a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18410wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18411
18412 Examples :
18413 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18414 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18415
18416 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18417 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18418
18419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184208.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18421---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018422
18423Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18424proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18425the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18426server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18427
18428Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18429response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018430section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018431
18432It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018433time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18434appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018435are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18436and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18437follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18438request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18439in the logs.
18440
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018441As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18442frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18443an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18444
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018445 Example :
18446 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18447 listen proxy-out
18448 mode http
18449 option httplog
18450 option logasap
18451 log global
18452 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18453
18454 # log the name of the virtual server
18455 capture request header Host len 20
18456
18457 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18458 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18459
18460 # log the beginning of the referrer
18461 capture request header Referer len 20
18462
18463 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18464 capture response header Server len 20
18465
18466 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18467 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18468
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018469 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018470 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18471
18472 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18473 capture response header Via len 20
18474
18475 # log the URL location during a redirection
18476 capture response header Location len 20
18477
18478 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18479 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18480 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18481 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18482 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18483
18484 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18485 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18486 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18487 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018488 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018489
18490 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18491 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18492 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18493 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18494 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018495 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018496
18497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184988.9. Examples of logs
18499---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018500
18501These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18502them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18503reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18504
18505 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18506 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18507 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18508
18509 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18510 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18511
18512 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18513 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18514 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18515
18516 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18517 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18518
18519 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18520 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18521 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18522
18523 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018524 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018525 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18526 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18527
18528 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18529 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18530 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18531
18532 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18533 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018534 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018535 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18536 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18537 to return the 502 and not the server.
18538
18539 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018540 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018541
18542 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18543 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18544 Nothing was sent to any server.
18545
18546 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18547 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18548
18549 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18550 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018551 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018552 send a 408 return code to the client.
18553
18554 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18555 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18556
18557 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18558 5 seconds ("c----").
18559
18560 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18561 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018562 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018563
18564 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018565 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018566 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18567 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18568 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18569 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18570 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018571
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018572
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200185739. Supported filters
18574--------------------
18575
18576Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18577accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18578unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18579
18580See also : "filter"
18581
185829.1. Trace
18583----------
18584
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018585filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018586
18587 Arguments:
18588 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18589 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18590
18591 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18592 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18593 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18594 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18595
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018596 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018597 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18598 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18599 amount of the parsed data.
18600
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018601 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018602
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018603This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18604callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18605information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18606filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18607
18608Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18609tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18610a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18611
18612
186139.2. HTTP compression
18614---------------------
18615
18616filter compression
18617
18618The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18619keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018620when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18621it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18622response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18623line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18624cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18625the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018626
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018627See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018628
18629
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200186309.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18631--------------------------------------------
18632
18633filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18634
18635 Arguments :
18636
18637 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18638 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18639 parsed.
18640
18641 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18642 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18643 part must be placed in its own scope.
18644
18645The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18646external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018647streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018648exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18649also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18650
18651SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18652the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18653
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018654For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018655"doc/SPOE.txt".
18656
18657Important note:
18658 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18659 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18660
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100186619.4. Cache
18662----------
18663
18664filter cache <name>
18665
18666 Arguments :
18667
18668 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18669
18670The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18671"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018672cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018673other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18674the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18675mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18676filter other than the compression is used for the same
18677listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18678order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018679
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018680See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018681
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001868210. Cache
18683---------
18684
18685HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18686(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18687RAM.
18688
18689The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018690this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018691
18692If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18693independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18694when we try to allocate a new one.
18695
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018696The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018697
18698It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18699"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18700for more details.
18701
18702When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18703replaced by "<CACHE>".
18704
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001870510.1. Limitation
18706----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018707
18708The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18709
18710- If the response is not a 200
18711- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018712- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018713- If the response is not cacheable
18714
18715- If the request is not a GET
18716- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018717- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018718
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018719Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18720filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18721can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18722example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18723"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018724
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001872510.2. Setup
18726-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018727
18728To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18729the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18730
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001873110.2.1. Cache section
18732---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018733
18734cache <name>
18735 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18736 size of cache is mandatory.
18737
18738total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018739 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018740 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018741
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018742max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018743 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18744 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18745 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018746
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018747max-age <seconds>
18748 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18749 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18750 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18751 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18752 default.
18753
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001875410.2.2. Proxy section
18755---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018756
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018757http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018758 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18759 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18760 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18761 after this one.
18762
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018763http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018764 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18765 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18766 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18767 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18768
18769
18770Example:
18771
18772 backend bck1
18773 mode http
18774
18775 http-request cache-use foobar
18776 http-response cache-store foobar
18777 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18778
18779 cache foobar
18780 total-max-size 4
18781 max-age 240
18782
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018783/*
18784 * Local variables:
18785 * fill-column: 79
18786 * End:
18787 */